blob: 8b165f88ab489f99f27126c57e9565738dd11a42 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaub7ffe192020-10-10 10:45:13 +02007 2020/10/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205
2061.2. HTTP request
207-----------------
208
209First, let's consider this HTTP request :
210
211 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100212 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
214 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
215 3 User-agent: my small browser
216 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
217 5 Accept: image/png
218
219
2201.2.1. The Request line
221-----------------------
222
223Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
224
225 - a METHOD : GET
226 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
227 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
228
229All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
230which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
231followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
232is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
233desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
234the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
235
236The URI itself can have several forms :
237
238 - A "relative URI" :
239
240 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
243 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
244
245 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
246
247 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
250 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
251 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
252 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
253 must accept this form too.
254
255 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
256 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
257 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200259 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
260 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
261 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
262 other protocols too.
263
264In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
265mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
266on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
267It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
268specific to the language, framework or application in use.
269
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100270HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100271assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273
2741.2.2. The request headers
275--------------------------
276
277The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
278beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
279an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
280Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
281values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
282encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
283the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
284define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100286Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100288"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200289as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
290normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
291representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
292HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293
294The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
295that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
296is one valid form of empty line.
297
298Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
299headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
300about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
301application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
302
303Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000304 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
306 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
307 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
308
309
3101.3. HTTP response
311------------------
312
313An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
314messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
315
316 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
319 2 Content-length: 350
320 3 Content-Type: text/html
321
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200322As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
323codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
324response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100325continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
326the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
327following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
328sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
329(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
330correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
331such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
332state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
333over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
334if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
335information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200337
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003381.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200339------------------------
340
341Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
342
343 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
344 - a status code : 200
345 - a reason : OK
346
347The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100348 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
349 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
350 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
351 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
352 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000354Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100355"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
357messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
358or "Authentication Required".
359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100360HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
362 Code When / reason
363 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
364 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
365 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100367 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369 400 for an invalid or too large request
370 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
371 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200372 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100373 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100375 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
376 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
479list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
480arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
481before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
483 Example:
484
485 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
486
487 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
488
489 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
492file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
495 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
496
497* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
498 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
499 directory.
500
501* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 processes, separated by semicolons.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 CLI, separated by semicolons.
508
509See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200510
5112.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200512----------------
513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100514Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100515values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
516otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
517numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
518for every keyword. Supported units are :
519
520 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
521 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
522 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
523 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
524 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
525 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
526
527
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005282.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200529-------------
530
531 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
532 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
533 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
534 global
535 daemon
536 maxconn 256
537
538 defaults
539 mode http
540 timeout connect 5000ms
541 timeout client 50000ms
542 timeout server 50000ms
543
544 frontend http-in
545 bind *:80
546 default_backend servers
547
548 backend servers
549 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
550
551
552 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
553 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
554 global
555 daemon
556 maxconn 256
557
558 defaults
559 mode http
560 timeout connect 5000ms
561 timeout client 50000ms
562 timeout server 50000ms
563
564 listen http-in
565 bind *:80
566 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
567
568
569Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
570
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100571 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200572
573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005743. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575--------------------
576
577Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
578are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
579of them have command-line equivalents.
580
581The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
582
583 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200584 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - description
590 - deviceatlas-json-file
591 - deviceatlas-log-level
592 - deviceatlas-separator
593 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900594 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200595 - gid
596 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100597 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200598 - h1-case-adjust
599 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100600 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100601 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100602 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200603 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100606 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100608 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200609 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200611 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200612 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200614 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - presetenv
616 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - uid
618 - ulimit-n
619 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200620 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100621 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-options
627 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200628 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-options
630 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100631 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200632 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100633 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100634 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100635 - 51degrees-data-file
636 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200637 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200638 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-data-file
640 - wurfl-information-list
641 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100643 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100646 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200647 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200649 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100650 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100651 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200653 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200654 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200655 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200656 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - noepoll
658 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000659 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100661 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300662 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000663 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100664 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200665 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200666 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200667 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000668 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000669 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200670 - tune.buffers.limit
671 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200672 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200673 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100674 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200675 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200676 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200677 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200678 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100679 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200680 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200681 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200682 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100683 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100684 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100685 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100686 - tune.lua.session-timeout
687 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200688 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100689 - tune.maxaccept
690 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200691 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200692 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200693 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200694 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
695 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100696 - tune.rcvbuf.client
697 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100698 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200699 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200700 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100701 - tune.sndbuf.client
702 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100703 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200704 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100705 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200706 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100707 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200708 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200709 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100710 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200711 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100712 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200713 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
714 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
715 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100716 - tune.zlib.memlevel
717 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100718
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200719 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200721 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722
723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007243.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200725------------------------------------
726
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200727ca-base <dir>
728 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100729 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
730 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
731 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200732
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200733chroot <jail dir>
734 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
735 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
736 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
737 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
738 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100739 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100740
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
742 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
743 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
744 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
745 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
746 set. These sets have the format
747
748 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
749
750 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100752 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
753 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100754 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
755 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100756 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100757 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100759 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
761 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
762 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
763 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100764
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100765 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
766 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
767 on the machine's word size.
768
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100769 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100770 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
771 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
772 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
773 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
774 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
775 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100776
777 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100778 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
779
780 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
781 # first 4 CPUs
782
783 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
784 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
785 # word size.
786
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100787 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100788 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100789 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
790 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
791 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
792
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100793 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
794 # and so on.
795 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
796 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
797 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
798
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100799 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100800 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
801 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
802 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
803
804 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
805 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
806 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
807
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100808 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
809 # and a thread range.
810 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
811 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
812 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
813
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200814crt-base <dir>
815 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100816 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
817 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819daemon
820 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
821 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100822 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
823 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200825deviceatlas-json-file <path>
826 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100827 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200828
829deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100830 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200831 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
832
833deviceatlas-separator <char>
834 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
835 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
836
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100837deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200838 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
839 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
840 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100841
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900842external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100843 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
844 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100845 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
846 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
847 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
848 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
849 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900850
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200851gid <number>
852 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
853 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
854 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100855 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
856 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200857 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100858
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100859group <group name>
860 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
861 See also "gid" and "user".
862
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100863hard-stop-after <time>
864 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
865
866 Arguments :
867 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
868 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
869 SIGUSR1 signal.
870
871 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
872 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
873 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
874
875 Example:
876 global
877 hard-stop-after 30s
878
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200879h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
880 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
881 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
882 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
883 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500884 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200885 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
886 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
887 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
888 specified in a proxy.
889
890 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
891 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
892 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
893 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
894 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
895 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
896 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
897
898 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
899 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
900 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
901 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
902 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
903
904 Example:
905 global
906 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
907
908 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
909 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
910
911h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
912 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
913 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
914 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
915 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
916 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
917 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
918 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
919 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
920
921 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
922 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
923 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
924
925 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
926 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
927
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100928insecure-fork-wanted
929 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
930 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
931 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
932 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
933 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
934 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
935 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
936 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
937 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
938 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
939 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
940 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
941 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
942 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
943 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
944 disable it.
945
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100946insecure-setuid-wanted
947 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
948 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
949 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
950 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
951 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
952 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
953 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
954 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
955 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
956 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
957 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
958 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
959 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
960 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
961
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100962issuers-chain-path <dir>
963 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
964 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
965 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
966 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
967 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
968 "issuers-chain-path".
969 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
970 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
971 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
972 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
973 will share the chain in memory.
974
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200975localpeer <name>
976 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
977 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
978 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
979 the configuration parsing.
980
981 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
982 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
983
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200984log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
985 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100986 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100987 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100988 configured with "log global".
989
990 <address> can be one of:
991
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100992 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100993 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
994 port).
995
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100996 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
997 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
998 port).
999
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001000 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001001 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1002 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001003 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001004
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001005 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1006 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1007 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1008 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1009 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1010 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1011 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1012 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1013 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1014 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1015 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1016 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1017 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1018 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001019 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1020 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001021
1022 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1023 "fd@2", see above.
1024
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001025 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1026 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1027 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1028 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1029 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1030
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001031 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1032 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001033
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001034 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1035 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1036 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1037 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1038 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1039 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1040 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1041 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1042 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1043 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001044 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1045 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001046
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001047 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1048 one of the following :
1049
1050 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1051 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1052
1053 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1054 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1055
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001056 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1057 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1058 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1059 designed to be used with a local log server.
1060
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001061 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1062 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1063 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1064 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1065 logger consumes.
1066
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001067 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1068 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1069 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1070 used with a local log server.
1071
1072 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1073 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1074 designed to be used with a local log server.
1075
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001076 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1077 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1078 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1079 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1080
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001081 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1082 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1083 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1084 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1085 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1086
1087 <sample_size>
1088 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1089 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1090 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1091 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1092 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1093
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001094 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001095
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001096 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1097 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1098 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1099
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001100 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1101 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1102 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1103 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001104
1105 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001106 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1107 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1108 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1109 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1110 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1111 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001112
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001113 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001114
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001115log-send-hostname [<string>]
1116 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1117 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1118 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1119 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1120 the logs.
1121
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001122log-tag <string>
1123 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1124 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1125 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001126 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001127
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001128lua-load <file>
1129 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1130 used multiple times.
1131
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001132lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1133 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1134 variable.
1135 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1136 to "path".
1137
1138 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1139 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1140 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1141 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1142 will be checked earlier.
1143
1144 As an example by specifying the following path:
1145
1146 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1147 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1148
1149 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1150 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1151 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1152 paths if that does not exist either.
1153
1154 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1155 documentation.
1156
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001157master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001158 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1159 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1160 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001161 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001162 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1163 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001164 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1165 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1166 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1167 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1168 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001169
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001170 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001171
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001172mworker-max-reloads <number>
1173 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001174 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001175 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1176 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1177 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1178
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001179nbproc <number>
1180 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1181 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1182 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001183 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1184 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001185 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1186 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001187
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001188nbthread <number>
1189 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001190 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1191 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1192 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1193 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1194 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001195 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1196 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1197 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1198 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1199 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1200 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1201 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001202
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001203pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001204 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1205 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1206 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1207 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001208
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001209pp2-never-send-local
1210 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1211 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1212 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1213 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1214 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1215 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1216 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1217 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1218 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1219 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1220 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1221
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001222presetenv <name> <value>
1223 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1224 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1225 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1226 and "unsetenv".
1227
1228resetenv [<name> ...]
1229 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1230 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1231 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1232 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1233 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1234 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1235 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1236 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1237
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001238stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001239 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1240 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1241 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1242 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1243 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1244 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001245 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001246 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1247 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1248 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1249 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001250
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001251server-state-base <directory>
1252 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001253 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1254 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001255
1256server-state-file <file>
1257 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1258 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1259 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1260 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1261 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1262 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1263 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1264 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001265 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1266 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001267
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001268setenv <name> <value>
1269 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1270 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1271 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1272 and "unsetenv".
1273
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001274set-dumpable
1275 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001276 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1277 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1278 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1279 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1280 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1281 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1282 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1283 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1284 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1285 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1286 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1287 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1288 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1289 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1290 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1291 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1292 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001293
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001294ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1295 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1296 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001297 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001298 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001299 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1300 information and recommendations see e.g.
1301 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1302 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1303 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1304 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001305
1306ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1308 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1309 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1310 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1311 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001312 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1313 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1314 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001315 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001316
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001317ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1319 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1320 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1321 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1322 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1323
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001324ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1325 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1326 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1327 keyword to see available options.
1328
1329 Example:
1330 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001331 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001332
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001333ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1334 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1335 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001336 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001337 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001338 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1339 information and recommendations see e.g.
1340 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1341 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1342 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1343 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1344 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001345
1346ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1347 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1348 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1349 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1350 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1351 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001352 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1353 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1354 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1355 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001356
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001357ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1358 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1359 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1360 keyword to see available options.
1361
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001362ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1364 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1365 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001366 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001367 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001368 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1369 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1370 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1371 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001372 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1373 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1374 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1375
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001376ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001377 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001378 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1379 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001380
1381 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1382 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1383 optimize the startup time.
1384
1385 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1386 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1387 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1388
1389 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001390 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001391
1392 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001393 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1394
1395 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1396 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1397 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1398 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1399 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1400 bind configuration..
1401
1402 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1403 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1404 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1405 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1406 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1407 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1408 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1409 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1410
1411 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1412
1413 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1414 a cert bundle.
1415
1416 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1417 separately in several "crt".
1418
1419 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1420 since files are loading separately.
1421
1422 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1423 required to commit them.
1424
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001425 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001426 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001427
1428 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1429
1430 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1431
1432 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1433 not provided in the PEM file.
1434
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001435 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1436 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1437
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001438 The default behavior is "all".
1439
1440 Example:
1441 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1442 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1443 ssl-load-extra-files none
1444
1445 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1446
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001447ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1448 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1449 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1450 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1451
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001452ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001453 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001454 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1455 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1456 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1457 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1458 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1459 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001460 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001461
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001462stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1463 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1464 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1465 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001466 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001467 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001468
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001469 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1470 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1471 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001472
1473stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1474 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1475 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001476 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001477
1478stats maxconn <connections>
1479 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1480 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1481
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001482uid <number>
1483 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1484 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1485 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1486 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1487
1488ulimit-n <number>
1489 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1490 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1491 option.
1492
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001493unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1494 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1495
1496 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1497 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1498 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1499 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1500 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1501 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1502 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1503 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1504 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1505 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1506
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001507unsetenv [<name> ...]
1508 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1509 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1510 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1511 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1512 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1513 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1514 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1515
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001516user <user name>
1517 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1518 See also "uid" and "group".
1519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001520node <name>
1521 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1522
1523 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1524 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1525 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1526 traffic.
1527
1528description <text>
1529 Add a text that describes the instance.
1530
1531 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1532 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1533 "<" and ">" characters.
1534
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100153551degrees-data-file <file path>
1536 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001537 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001538
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001539 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001540 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1541
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000154251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001543 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1544 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1545 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1546
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001547 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001548 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1549
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200155051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001551 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1552 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1553
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001554 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1555 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1556
155751degrees-cache-size <number>
1558 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1559 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1560 By default, this cache is disabled.
1561
1562 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001563 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1564
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001565wurfl-data-file <file path>
1566 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1567 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1568
1569 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1570 with USE_WURFL=1.
1571
1572wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1573 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1574 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1575 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1576
1577 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1578
1579 Valid WURFL properties are:
1580 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1581
1582 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1583 device.
1584
1585 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1586 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1587
1588 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1589 particular web request.
1590
1591 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1592 used Libwurfl API version.
1593
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001594 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1595 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1596
1597 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1598 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1599
1600 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1601
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001602 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1603 with USE_WURFL=1.
1604
1605wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1606 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1607 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1608
1609 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1610 with USE_WURFL=1.
1611
1612wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1613 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1614 thus before the chroot.
1615
1616 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1617 with USE_WURFL=1.
1618
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001619wurfl-cache-size <size>
1620 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1621 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001622 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001623 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001624
1625 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1626 with USE_WURFL=1.
1627
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001628strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001629 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1630 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1631 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1632 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1633 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016353.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001636-----------------------
1637
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001638busy-polling
1639 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1640 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1641 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1642 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1643 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1644 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1645 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1646 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1647 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1648 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1649 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1650 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1651 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1652 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1653 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1654 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1655 "poll" pollers.
1656
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001657 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1658 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1659 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1660
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001661max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1662 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1663 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1664 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1665 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1666 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1667 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1668 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1669 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1670
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001671maxconn <number>
1672 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1673 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1674 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001675 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1676 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1677 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1678 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001679 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1680 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1681 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1682 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1683 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1684 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001685
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001686maxconnrate <number>
1687 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1688 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1689 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1690 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1691 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1692 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1693 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1694 fairness.
1695
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001696maxcomprate <number>
1697 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001698 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001699 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1700 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1701 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001702 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001703 default value.
1704
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001705maxcompcpuusage <number>
1706 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1707 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1708 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1709 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1710 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1711 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1712 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1713 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1714
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001715maxpipes <number>
1716 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1717 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1718 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1719 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1720 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1721 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1722
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001723maxsessrate <number>
1724 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1725 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1726 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1727 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1728 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1729 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1730 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1731 fairness.
1732
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001733maxsslconn <number>
1734 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1735 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1736 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1737 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1738 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1739 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1740 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001741 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1742 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1743 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1744 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1745 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1746 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1747 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001748
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001749maxsslrate <number>
1750 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1751 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1752 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1753 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1754 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1755 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1756 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1757 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1758 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1759 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1760
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001761maxzlibmem <number>
1762 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1763 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1764 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001765 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1766 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1767 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1768
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001769noepoll
1770 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1771 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001772 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001773
1774nokqueue
1775 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1776 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1777 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1778
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001779noevports
1780 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1781 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1782 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1783 also "nopoll".
1784
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001785nopoll
1786 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1787 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001788 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001789 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1790 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001791
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001792nosplice
1793 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001794 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001795 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001796 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001797 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1798 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1799 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1800 "option splice-response".
1801
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001802nogetaddrinfo
1803 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1804 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1805
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001806noreuseport
1807 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1808 command line argument "-dR".
1809
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001810profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1811 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1812 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1813 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1814 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001815 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001816 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1817 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1818 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1819 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1820
1821 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1822 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1823 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1824 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1825 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001826 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1827 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1828 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1829 CLI.
1830
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001831spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001832 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1833 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1834 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1835 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1836 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1837 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001838
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001839ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001840 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001841 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001842 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1843 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1844 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1845 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1846 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001847 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1848 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001849 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1850 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1851 openssl configuration file uses:
1852 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1853
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001854ssl-mode-async
1855 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001856 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001857 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1858 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1859 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001860 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001861 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001862
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001863tune.buffers.limit <number>
1864 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1865 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1866 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1867 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1868 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001869 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001870 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1871 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1872 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1873 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1874 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1875 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1876 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1877 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1878 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1879
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001880tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1881 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1882 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1883 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1884 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1885
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001886tune.bufsize <number>
1887 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1888 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1889 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1890 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1891 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1892 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1893 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001894 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1895 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1896 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001897 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001898 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1899 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1900 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001901
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001902tune.chksize <number>
1903 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1904 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1905 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1906 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1907 checks whenever possible.
1908
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001909tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1910 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1911 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1912 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1913 this value. The default value is 1.
1914
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001915tune.fail-alloc
1916 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1917 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1918 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1919 gracefully.
1920
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001921tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1922 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1923 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1924 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1925 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1926 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1927
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001928tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1929 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1930 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1931 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1932 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1933 change it.
1934
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001935tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1936 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001937 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1938 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001939 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1940 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1941 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1942 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1943 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1944
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001945tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1946 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1947 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1948 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1949 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1950 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1951 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1952 recommended not to change this value.
1953
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001954tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1955 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1956 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1957 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1958 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1959 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1960 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1961 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1962
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001963tune.http.cookielen <number>
1964 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1965 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1966 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1967 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1968 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1969 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1970 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1971 to change this value.
1972
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001973tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001974 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1975 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001976 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001977 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001978 configuration directives too.
1979 The default value is 1024.
1980
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001981tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1982 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1983 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1984 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1985 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1986 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1987 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001988 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1989 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1990 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001991
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001992tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
1993 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
1994 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
1995 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
1996 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
1997 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
1998 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
1999 this option to "off". The default is on.
2000
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002001tune.idletimer <timeout>
2002 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2003 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2004 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2005 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2006 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2007 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002008 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002009 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002010 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2011
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002012tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2013 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2014 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2015 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2016 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2017 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2018 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2019 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2020 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2021 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2022
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002023tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2024 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002025 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002026 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2027 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002028 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002029 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2030 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2031
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002032tune.lua.maxmem
2033 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2034 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2035 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2036 memory.
2037
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002038tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2039 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002040 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2041 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002042 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002043
2044tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2045 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2046 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2047 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2048 check servers.
2049
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002050tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2051 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2052 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2053 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002054 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002055
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002056tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002057 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2058 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2059 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2060 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2061 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2062 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2063 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2064 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2065 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2066 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002067
2068tune.maxpollevents <number>
2069 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2070 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2071 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2072 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2073 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2074
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002075tune.maxrewrite <number>
2076 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2077 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2078 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2079 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2080 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2081 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2082 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2083 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2084 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2085 bufsize.
2086
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002087tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2088 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2089 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2090 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2091 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2092 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2093 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2094 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2095 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2096 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002097 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2098 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002099 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2100 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2101 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2102 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2103 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2104 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2105 setting this parameter to 0.
2106
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002107tune.pipesize <number>
2108 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2109 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2110 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2111 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2112 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2113 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2114
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002115tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2116 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2117 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2118 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2119 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2120 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2121 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002122 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002123
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002124tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2125 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2126 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2127 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2128 default is 20.
2129
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002130tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2131tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2132 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2133 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2134 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002135 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002136 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002137 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2138 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2139
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002140tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002141 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002142 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2143 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2144 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2145 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2146
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002147tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002148 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002149 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002150 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2151 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2152 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2153
2154tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2155 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2156 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2157 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2158 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2159 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2160 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2161 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2162 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2163 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002164
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002165tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2166tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2167 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2168 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2169 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002170 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002171 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002172 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2173 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2174 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2175 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2176 notifying haproxy again.
2177
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002178tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002179 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2180 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2181 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002182 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002183 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002184 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002185 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2186 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2187 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002188 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2189 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002190
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002191tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002192 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002193 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2194 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2195 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2196 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2197 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2198
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002199tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2200 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2201 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2202 performances. This is disabled by default.
2203
2204 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2205 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2206
2207 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2208
2209 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2210
2211 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2212
2213 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2214 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2215 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2216
2217 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2218 converted.
2219
2220 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2221 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2222 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2223 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2224 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2225 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2226 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002227 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2228 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002229
2230 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2231
2232 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2233 only need this line:
2234
2235 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2236
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002237tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2238 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002239 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002240 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2241 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2242 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2243 being used for too long.
2244
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002245tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2246 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2247 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2248 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2249 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2250 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2251 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2252 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2253 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2254 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2255 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002256 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002257 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002258
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002259tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2260 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2261 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2262 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2263 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002264 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002265 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2266 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002267 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2268 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002269
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002270tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2271 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2272 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2273 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2274 1000 entries.
2275
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002276tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2277 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2278 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2279 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2280
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002281tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002282tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002283tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2284tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2285tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002286 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2287 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2288 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2289 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2290 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2291 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2292 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2293 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002294
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002295 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2296 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2297 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2298 all available space is consumed.
2299 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2300 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2301 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002302
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002303tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2304 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002305 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002306 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002307 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002308 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2309
2310tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2311 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2312 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002313 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2314 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023163.3. Debugging
2317--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002318
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002319quiet
2320 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2321 line argument "-q".
2322
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002323zero-warning
2324 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2325 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2326 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2327 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2328 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2329 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2330
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002331
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010023323.4. Userlists
2333--------------
2334It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2335http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2336it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2337
2338userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002339 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002340 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2341
2342group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002343 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002344 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2345 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2346
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002347user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2348 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002349 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2350 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002351 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2352 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2353 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2354 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002355
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002356 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2357 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2358 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2359 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2360 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2361 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2362 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2363 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2364 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002365
2366 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002367 userlist L1
2368 group G1 users tiger,scott
2369 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002370
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002371 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2372 user scott insecure-password elgato
2373 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002374
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002375 userlist L2
2376 group G1
2377 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002378
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002379 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2380 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2381 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002382
2383 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002384
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002385
23863.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002387----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002388It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2389several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2390instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2391values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2392automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2393In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2394using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2395tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2396reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2397Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2398that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2399each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002400
2401peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002402 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002403 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2404
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002405bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2406 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2407 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2408
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002409disabled
2410 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2411 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2412 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2413
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002414default-bind [param*]
2415 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2416
2417default-server [param*]
2418 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2419
2420 Arguments:
2421 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2422 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2423 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2424 details.
2425
2426
2427 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2428
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002429enable
2430 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2431
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002432log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2433 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2434 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2435 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2436 more details.
2437
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002438peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002439 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2440 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002441 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2442 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2443 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2444 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2445 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002446
2447 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2448 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2449
2450 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002451 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2452 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2453 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002454
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002455 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2456 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002457
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002458 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2459 "server" keyword explanation below).
2460
2461server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002462 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002463 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2464 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2465 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2466 of this "peers" section).
2467 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2468
2469
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002470 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002471 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002472 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002473 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2474 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2475 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002476
2477 backend mybackend
2478 mode tcp
2479 balance roundrobin
2480 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2481 stick on src
2482
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002483 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2484 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002485
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002486 Example:
2487 peers mypeers
2488 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2489 default-server ssl verify none
2490 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2491 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002492
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002493
2494table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2495 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2496
2497 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2498 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002499 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002500 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2501 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2502 "stick-table" keyword).
2503
2504 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2505 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2506 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2507 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2508 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2509 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2510 of the stick-table name as follows:
2511
2512 peers mypeers
2513 peer A ...
2514 peer B ...
2515 table t1 ...
2516
2517 frontend fe1
2518 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2519
2520 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2521 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2522
2523 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2524 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2525 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2526 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2527 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2528 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2529 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2530
2531 peers mypeers
2532 peer A ...
2533 peer B ...
2534 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2535
2536 backend t1
2537 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2538
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002539 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002540 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2541 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2542
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090025433.6. Mailers
2544------------
2545It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2546If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2547in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2548
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002549mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002550 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2551 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2552
2553mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2554 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2555
2556 Example:
2557 mailers mymailers
2558 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2559 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2560
2561 backend mybackend
2562 mode tcp
2563 balance roundrobin
2564
2565 email-alert mailers mymailers
2566 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2567 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2568
2569 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2570 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2571
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002572timeout mail <time>
2573 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2574 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2575 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2576 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2577
2578 Example:
2579 mailers mymailers
2580 timeout mail 20s
2581 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002582
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025833.7. Programs
2584-------------
2585In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2586master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2587managed the same way as the workers.
2588
2589During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2590sequence as a worker:
2591
2592 - the master is re-executed
2593 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2594 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2595 instance of the program
2596
2597During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2598
2599program <name>
2600 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2601 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2602 the management guide).
2603
2604command <command> [arguments*]
2605 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2606 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2607 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2608 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2609
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002610user <user name>
2611 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2612 See also "group".
2613
2614group <group name>
2615 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2616 See also "user".
2617
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002618option start-on-reload
2619no option start-on-reload
2620 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2621 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2622 program section.
2623
2624
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010026253.8. HTTP-errors
2626----------------
2627
2628It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2629imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2630several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2631
2632http-errors <name>
2633 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2634 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2635
2636errorfile <code> <file>
2637 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2638
2639 Arguments :
2640 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002641 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2642 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002643
2644 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2645 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2646 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2647 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2648 before any chroot is performed.
2649
2650 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2651
2652 Example:
2653 http-errors website-1
2654 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2655 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2656 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2657
2658 http-errors website-2
2659 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2660 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2661 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2662
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020026633.9. Rings
2664----------
2665
2666It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2667servers or traces.
2668
2669ring <ringname>
2670 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2671
2672description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002673 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002674 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2675
2676format <format>
2677 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2678
2679 Arguments:
2680 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2681 one of the following :
2682
2683 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2684 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2685 designed to be used with a local log server.
2686
2687 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2688 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2689 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2690 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2691 is the default.
2692
2693 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2694 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2695
2696 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2697 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2698
2699 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2700 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2701 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2702 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2703 logger consumes.
2704
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002705 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2706 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2707 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2708 with a local log server.
2709
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002710 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2711 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2712 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2713 used with a local log server.
2714
2715maxlen <length>
2716 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2717 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2718 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2719
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002720server <name> <address> [param*]
2721 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2722 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2723 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2724 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2725 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2726 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2727 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2728 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2729 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002730 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2731 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002732
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002733size <size>
2734 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2735 set to BUFSIZE.
2736
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002737timeout connect <timeout>
2738 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2739
2740 Arguments :
2741 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2742 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2743 as explained at the top of this document.
2744
2745timeout server <timeout>
2746 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2747
2748 Arguments :
2749 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2750 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2751 as explained at the top of this document.
2752
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002753 Example:
2754 global
2755 log ring@myring local7
2756
2757 ring myring
2758 description "My local buffer"
2759 format rfc3164
2760 maxlen 1200
2761 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002762 timeout connect 5s
2763 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002764 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002765
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020027663.10. Log forwarding
2767-------------------
2768
2769It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
2770haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
2771
2772log-forward <name>
2773 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
2774
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002775backlog <conns>
2776 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2777 on connections accept.
2778
2779bind <addr> [param*]
2780 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02002781 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
2782 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
2783 syslog protocol over TCP.
2784 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002785 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
2786
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02002787dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002788 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
2789 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
2790 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
2791 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02002792 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02002793
2794log global
2795log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2796 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2797 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
2798 documentation.
2799 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
2800 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
2801 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
2802 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
2803 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
2804
2805 Example:
2806 global
2807 log stderr format iso local7
2808
2809 ring myring
2810 description "My local buffer"
2811 format rfc5424
2812 maxlen 1200
2813 size 32764
2814 timeout connect 5s
2815 timeout server 10s
2816 # syslog tcp server
2817 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
2818
2819 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002820 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
2821 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02002822 # all messages on stderr
2823 log global
2824 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
2825 log ring@myring local0
2826 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
2827 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
2828 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
2829 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
2830 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002831
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002832maxconn <conns>
2833 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
2834 10 is the default.
2835
2836timeout client <timeout>
2837 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028394. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002840----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002842Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002843 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002844 - frontend <name>
2845 - backend <name>
2846 - listen <name>
2847
2848A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2849its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2850section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002851section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002852
2853A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2854connections.
2855
2856A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2857to forward incoming connections.
2858
2859A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2860parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2861
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002862All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2863'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2864case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2865
2866Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2867logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2868proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2869However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2870name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2871
2872Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2873and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002874bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002875protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2876modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2877arbitrary criteria.
2878
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002879In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2880a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002881the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002882
2883 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2884 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2885 between responses and new requests.
2886
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002887 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2888 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2889 client-facing connection remains open.
2890
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002891 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2892 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002893
2894The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2895frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2896following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002897weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002898
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002899 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002900
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002901 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2902 ----+-----+-----+----
2903 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2904 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002905 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2906 ----+-----+-----+----
2907 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002908
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002909
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029114.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2912--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002913
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002914The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2915limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2916they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2917limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002918marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002919option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002920and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2921with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2922specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002923
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002924
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002925 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2926------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2927acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002928backlog X X X -
2929balance X - X X
2930bind - X X -
2931bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002932capture cookie - X X -
2933capture request header - X X -
2934capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09002935clitcpka-cnt X X X -
2936clitcpka-idle X X X -
2937clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002938compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002939cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002940declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002941default-server X - X X
2942default_backend X X X -
2943description - X X X
2944disabled X X X X
2945dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002946email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002947email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002948email-alert mailers X X X X
2949email-alert myhostname X X X X
2950email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002951enabled X X X X
2952errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002953errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002954errorloc X X X X
2955errorloc302 X X X X
2956-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2957errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002958force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002959filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002960fullconn X - X X
2961grace X X X X
2962hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002963http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002964http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002965http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002966http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002967http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002968http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002969http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002970http-check set-var X - X X
2971http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002972http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002973http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002974http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002975http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002976http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002977id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002978ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002979load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002980log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002981log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002982log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002983log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002984max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002985maxconn X X X -
2986mode X X X X
2987monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002988monitor-uri X X X -
2989option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2990option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2991option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2992option allbackups (*) X - X X
2993option checkcache (*) X - X X
2994option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2995option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002996option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002997option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2998option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002999-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3000option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003001option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3002option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003003option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003004option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003005option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003006option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003007option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003008option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3009option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3010option httpchk X - X X
3011option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003012option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003013option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003014option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003015option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003016option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003017option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3018option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3019option logasap (*) X X X -
3020option mysql-check X - X X
3021option nolinger (*) X X X X
3022option originalto X X X X
3023option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003024option pgsql-check X - X X
3025option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003026option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003027option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003028option smtpchk X - X X
3029option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3030option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3031option splice-request (*) X X X X
3032option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003033option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003034option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3035option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3036-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003037option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003038option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3039option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3040option tcpka X X X X
3041option tcplog X X X X
3042option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003043external-check command X - X X
3044external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003045persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3046rate-limit sessions X X X -
3047redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003048-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003049retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003050retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003051server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003052server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003053server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003054source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003055srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3056srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3057srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003058stats admin - X X X
3059stats auth X X X X
3060stats enable X X X X
3061stats hide-version X X X X
3062stats http-request - X X X
3063stats realm X X X X
3064stats refresh X X X X
3065stats scope X X X X
3066stats show-desc X X X X
3067stats show-legends X X X X
3068stats show-node X X X X
3069stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003070-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3071stick match - - X X
3072stick on - - X X
3073stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003074stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003075stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003076tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003077tcp-check connect X - X X
3078tcp-check expect X - X X
3079tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003080tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003081tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003082tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003083tcp-check set-var X - X X
3084tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003085tcp-request connection - X X -
3086tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003087tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003088tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003089tcp-response content - - X X
3090tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003091timeout check X - X X
3092timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003093timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003094timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003095timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3096timeout http-request X X X X
3097timeout queue X - X X
3098timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003099timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003100timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003101timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003102transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003103unique-id-format X X X -
3104unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003105use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003106use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003107use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003108------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3109 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003110
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031124.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3113---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003114
3115This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3116
3117
3118acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3119 Declare or complete an access list.
3120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3121 no | yes | yes | yes
3122 Example:
3123 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3124 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3125 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003127 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128
3129
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003130backlog <conns>
3131 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3133 yes | yes | yes | no
3134 Arguments :
3135 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3136 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003137 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003138
3139 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3140 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3141 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3142 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3143 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3144 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3145 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3146 backlog parameter.
3147
3148 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3149 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3150 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3151
3152 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3153
3154
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003155balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003156balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3159 yes | no | yes | yes
3160 Arguments :
3161 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3162 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3163 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3164 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3165
3166 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3167 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3168 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3169 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003170 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003171 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003172 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3173 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3174 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3175 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3176 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3177 it, so that you don't worry.
3178
3179 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3180 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3181 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3182 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3183 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3184 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3185 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3186 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003187
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003188 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3189 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3190 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3191 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3192 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3193 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3194 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3195 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3196
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003197 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003198 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003199 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3200 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003201 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003202 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3203 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3204 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3205 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3206 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003207 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3208 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3209 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3210 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3211 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3212 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003213
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003214 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3215 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3216 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3217 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3218 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3219 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3220 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3221 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003222 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003223 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003224 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3225 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3226 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003227
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003228 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3229 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3230 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3231 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3232 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3233 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3234 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3235 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3236 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3237 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3238 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3239 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003240
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003241 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003242 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3243 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3244 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3245 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3246 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3247 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3248 URIs start with a leading "/".
3249
3250 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3251 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3252 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3253 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3254
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003255 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3256 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3257 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3258 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3259
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003260 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003261 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3262
3263 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003264 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3265 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003266 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3267 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3268 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3269 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003270 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003271 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3272 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003273
3274 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3275 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3276 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3277 server will receive the request.
3278
3279 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3280 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3281 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3282 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3283 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003284 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3285 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3286 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003287
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003288 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3289 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3290 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3291 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3292 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003293
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003294 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003295 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3296 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3297 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3298
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003299 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3300 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3301 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3302
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003303 random
3304 random(<draws>)
3305 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003306 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3307 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3308 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3309 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003310 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3311 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3312 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3313 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3314 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3315 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3316 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3317 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3318 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3319 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3320 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3321 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3322 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3323 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3324 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3325 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3326 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3327 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3328 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3329 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003330
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003331 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003332 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003333 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3334 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3335 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3336 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3337 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3338 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003339 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003340 used instead.
3341
3342 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3343 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3344 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3345 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3346
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003347 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3348 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3349 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3350
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003351 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003353 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003354 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3355 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003356
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003357 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3358 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3359 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003360
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003361 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003362 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003363 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3364 NTLM relies on.
3365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366 Examples :
3367 balance roundrobin
3368 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003369 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003370 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3371 balance hdr(host)
3372 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003373
3374 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3375 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003377 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003378 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3379 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3380 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003381 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003382
3383 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3384 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3385 defaults to 16 kB.
3386
3387 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3388 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3389
3390 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3391 Round Robin.
3392
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003393 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003394 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3395 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3396 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3397
3398 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3399
3400 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003401 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003402 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3403 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3404 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003405
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003406 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003407
3408
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003409bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3410bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003411 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3413 no | yes | yes | no
3414 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003415 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3416 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3417 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3418 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003419 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003420 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3421 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3422 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3423 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3424 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3425 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003426 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003427 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3428 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003429 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003430 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3431 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003432 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003433 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3434 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003435 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003436 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3437 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3438 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3439 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3440 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3441 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3442 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003443 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3444 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3445 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003446 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3447 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3448 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3449 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003450 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3451 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3452 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003453
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003454 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3455 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003456 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3457 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3458 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003459 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3460 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3461 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3462 the range.
3463
3464 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3465 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3466 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3467 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3468 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3469 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3470 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003471 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003472 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003473
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003474 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003475 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003476 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3477 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3478 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3479 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3480 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3481 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3482
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003483 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3484 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3485 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3486 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003487
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003488 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3489 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3490 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3491 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3492 in a frontend.
3493
3494 Example :
3495 listen http_proxy
3496 bind :80,:443
3497 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003498 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003499
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003500 listen http_https_proxy
3501 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003502 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003503
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003504 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3505 bind ipv6@:80
3506 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3507 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3508
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003509 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003510 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003511
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003512 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3513 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3514 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3515 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3516 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3517
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003518 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003519 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003520
3521
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003522bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003523 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3525 yes | yes | yes | yes
3526 Arguments :
3527 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3528 may be used to override a default value.
3529
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003530 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003531 option may be combined with other numbers.
3532
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003533 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003534 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3535 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3536 missing from all processes.
3537
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003538 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003539 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003540 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3541 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3542 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3543 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3544 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003545 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003546
3547 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3548 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3549 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3550 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3551 and 'even' instances.
3552
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003553 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3554 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3555 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3556 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003557
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003558 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3559 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3560
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003561 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3562 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3563 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3564
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003565 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3566 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3567
3568 Example :
3569 listen app_ip1
3570 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003571 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003572
3573 listen app_ip2
3574 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003575 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003576
3577 listen management
3578 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003579 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003580
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003581 listen management
3582 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3583 bind-process 1-4
3584
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003585 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003586
3587
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003588capture cookie <name> len <length>
3589 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3591 no | yes | yes | no
3592 Arguments :
3593 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3594 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3595 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3596 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003597 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598
3599 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3600 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3601 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3602 right if it exceeds <length>.
3603
3604 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3605 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3606 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3607 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3608
3609 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3610 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3611 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3612
3613 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3614 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3615 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003616 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3617 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3618 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003619
3620 Example:
3621 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3622
3623 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003624 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003625
3626
3627capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003628 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3630 no | yes | yes | no
3631 Arguments :
3632 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003633 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003634 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3635 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3636 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3637
3638 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3639 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3640 it exceeds <length>.
3641
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003642 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003643 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3644 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003645 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3646 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3647 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3648 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003649 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003650 environments to find where the request came from.
3651
3652 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3653 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3654 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3655 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003656
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003657 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3658 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3659 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3660 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3661 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003662
3663 Example:
3664 capture request header Host len 15
3665 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003666 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003668 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003669 about logging.
3670
3671
3672capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003673 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3675 no | yes | yes | no
3676 Arguments :
3677 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003678 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003679 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3680 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3681 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3682
3683 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3684 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3685 it exceeds <length>.
3686
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003687 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003688 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3689 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3690 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003691 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3692 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3693 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3694 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003695
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003696 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3697 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3698 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3699 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3700 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003701
3702 Example:
3703 capture response header Content-length len 9
3704 capture response header Location len 15
3705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003706 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003707 about logging.
3708
3709
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003710clitcpka-cnt <count>
3711 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3712 the connection on the client side.
3713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3714 yes | yes | yes | no
3715 Arguments :
3716 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3717
3718 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3719 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003720 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3721 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003722
3723 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3724
3725
3726clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3727 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3728 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3729 client side.
3730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3731 yes | yes | yes | no
3732 Arguments :
3733 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3734 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3735 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3736 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3737
3738 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3739 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003740 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3741 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003742
3743 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3744
3745
3746clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3747 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3749 yes | yes | yes | no
3750 Arguments :
3751 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
3752 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
3753 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
3754 document.
3755
3756 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
3757 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003758 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3759 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003760
3761 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
3762
3763
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003764compression algo <algorithm> ...
3765compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003766compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003767 Enable HTTP compression.
3768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3769 yes | yes | yes | yes
3770 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003771 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3772 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3773 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3774
3775 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003776 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3777 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3778 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003779
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003780 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003781 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003782
3783 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3784 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3785 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3786 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3787 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003788 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003789
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003790 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3791 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3792 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3793 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3794 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3795 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3796 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003797 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003798
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003799 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003800 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003801 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3802 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3803 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3804 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3805 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003806
3807 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3808 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3809 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3810 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3811 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003812 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3813 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3814 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3815 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3816 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003817 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3818 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003819
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003820 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003821 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3822 "Accept-Encoding" header
3823 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003824 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003825 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3826 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3827 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3828 "multipart"
3829 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3830 header
3831 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3832 and later
3833 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3834 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003835 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003836
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003837 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003838
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003839 Examples :
3840 compression algo gzip
3841 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003842
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003843
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003844cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003845 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3846 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003847 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003848 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3850 yes | no | yes | yes
3851 Arguments :
3852 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3853 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3854 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3855 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3856 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3857 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003858 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003859 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3860 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3861
3862 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3863 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3864 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3865 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3866 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3867 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003868 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3869 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003870 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003871 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3872 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003873
3874 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003875 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003876
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003877 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003878 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003879 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003880 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003881 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3882 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3883 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3884 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3885 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3886 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3887 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003888
3889 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3890 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3891 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3892 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3893 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3894 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3895 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3896 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3897 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003898 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003899 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3900 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3901 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003902
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003903 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3904 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3905 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003906 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3907 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3908 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3909 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003910 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3911 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3912 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003913
3914 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3915 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3916 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3917 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3918 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3919 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3920 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3921 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3922 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3923
3924 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3925 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3926 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3927 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3928 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3929 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3930 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3931 persistence cookie in the cache.
3932 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3933
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003934 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3935 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3936 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3937 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3938 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003939 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003940 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3941 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3942 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3943 they logout.
3944
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003945 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3946 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3947 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3948 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3949
3950 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3951 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3952 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3953 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3954 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3955 this attribute.
3956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003957 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003958 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003959 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3960 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3961 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3962 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3963 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3964 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003965
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003966 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3967 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3968 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3969 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3970 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3971 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3972 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3973 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003974 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003975 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3976 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3977 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3978 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3979 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3980 the site.
3981
3982 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3983 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3984 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3985 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3986 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3987 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3988 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3989 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3990 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3991 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3992 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3993 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3994 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003995 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003996 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3997 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3998
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003999 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4000 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4001 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4002 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4003 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4004 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4005
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004006 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4007 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4008 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4009 repeated.
4010
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004011 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4012 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4013 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4014 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004015
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004016 Examples :
4017 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4018 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4019 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004020 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004021
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004022 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004023
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004024
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004025declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4026 Declares a capture slot.
4027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4028 no | yes | yes | no
4029 Arguments:
4030 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4031
4032 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4033 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4034 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4035 for use in the response.
4036
4037 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004038 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004039 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4040
4041
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004042default-server [param*]
4043 Change default options for a server in a backend
4044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4045 yes | no | yes | yes
4046 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004047 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4048 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4049 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4050 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004051
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004052 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004053 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4054
4055 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004056
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004057
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004058default_backend <backend>
4059 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4061 yes | yes | yes | no
4062 Arguments :
4063 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4064
4065 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4066 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4067 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4068 will catch all undetermined requests.
4069
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004070 Example :
4071
4072 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4073 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4074 default_backend dynamic
4075
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004076 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004078
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004079description <string>
4080 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4082 no | yes | yes | yes
4083 Arguments : string
4084
4085 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4086 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4087 it describes.
4088 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4089
4090
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004091disabled
4092 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4094 yes | yes | yes | yes
4095 Arguments : none
4096
4097 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4098 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4099 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4100 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4101 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4102 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4103 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4104
4105 See also : "enabled"
4106
4107
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004108dispatch <address>:<port>
4109 Set a default server address
4110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4111 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004112 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004113
4114 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4115 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4116 during start-up.
4117
4118 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4119 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4120 possible with normal servers.
4121
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004122 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004123 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4124 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4125 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4126 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4127
4128 See also : "server"
4129
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004130
4131dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4132 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4134 yes | no | yes | yes
4135 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4136
4137 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004138 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004139 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4140 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004141 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004142 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004143
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004144enabled
4145 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4147 yes | yes | yes | yes
4148 Arguments : none
4149
4150 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4151 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4152
4153 See also : "disabled"
4154
4155
4156errorfile <code> <file>
4157 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4159 yes | yes | yes | yes
4160 Arguments :
4161 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004162 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004163 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004164
4165 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004166 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004167 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004168 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4169 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004170
4171 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4172 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4173 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4174
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004175 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4176
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004177 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4178 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4179 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4180 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4181 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4182 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4183 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4184 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4185 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004186
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004187 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4188 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4189 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004190 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004191 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4192
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004193 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004194
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004195 Example :
4196 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004197 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004198 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4199 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4200
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004201
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004202errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4203 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4204 section.
4205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4206 yes | yes | yes | yes
4207 Arguments :
4208 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4209
4210 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004211 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004212 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004213
4214 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4215 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4216 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4217 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4218 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004219 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004220 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4221
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004222 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4223 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004224
4225 Example :
4226 errorfiles generic
4227 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4228
4229
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004230errorloc <code> <url>
4231errorloc302 <code> <url>
4232 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4234 yes | yes | yes | yes
4235 Arguments :
4236 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004237 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004238 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004239
4240 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4241 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4242 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4243 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004244 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004245
4246 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4247 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4248 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4249
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004250 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4251
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004252 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4253 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4254 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4255 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004256 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004257 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4258 request.
4259
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004260 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004261
4262
4263errorloc303 <code> <url>
4264 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4266 yes | yes | yes | yes
4267 Arguments :
4268 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004269 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004270 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004271
4272 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4273 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4274 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4275 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004276 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004277
4278 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4279 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4280 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4281
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004282 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4283
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004284 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4285 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4286 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4287 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004288 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004289
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004290 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004291
4292
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004293email-alert from <emailaddr>
4294 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004295 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4297 yes | yes | yes | yes
4298
4299 Arguments :
4300
4301 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4302
4303 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4304 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4305
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004306 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004307 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4308 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004309
4310
4311email-alert level <level>
4312 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4313 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4314 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4315 yes | yes | yes | yes
4316
4317 Arguments :
4318
4319 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4320 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4321 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4322
4323 By default level is alert
4324
4325 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4326 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4327 for the proxy.
4328
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004329 Alerts are sent when :
4330
4331 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4332 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4333 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4334 is notice or lower
4335 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4336 and a health check status update occurs
4337
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004338 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4339 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004340 section 3.6 about mailers.
4341
4342
4343email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4344 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4345 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4346 yes | yes | yes | yes
4347
4348 Arguments :
4349
4350 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4351
4352 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4353 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4354
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004355 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4356 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004357
4358
4359email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4360 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4361 mailers.
4362 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4363 yes | yes | yes | yes
4364
4365 Arguments :
4366
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004367 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004368
4369 By default the systems hostname is used.
4370
4371 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4372 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4373 for the proxy.
4374
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004375 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4376 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004377
4378
4379email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004380 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004381 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4382 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4383 yes | yes | yes | yes
4384
4385 Arguments :
4386
4387 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4388
4389 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4390 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4391
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004392 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004393 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4394
4395
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004396force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4397 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4398 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004399 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004400
4401 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4402 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4403 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4404 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4405 marked down for maintenance operations.
4406
4407 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4408 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4409 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4410 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4411 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4412 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4413 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4414 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4415 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4416
4417 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4418 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4419 is used.
4420
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004421 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004422 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004423
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004424
4425filter <name> [param*]
4426 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4428 no | yes | yes | yes
4429 Arguments :
4430 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4431 referenced in section 9.
4432
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004433 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004434 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004435 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4436 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004437
4438 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4439 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4440
4441 Example:
4442 listen
4443 bind *:80
4444
4445 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4446 filter compression
4447 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4448
4449 compression algo gzip
4450 compression offload
4451
4452 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4453
4454 See also : section 9.
4455
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004456
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004457fullconn <conns>
4458 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4460 yes | no | yes | yes
4461 Arguments :
4462 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4463 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4464
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004465 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004466 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004467 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004468 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4469 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4470 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4471 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4472 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004473 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004474
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004475 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4476 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004477 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4478 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4479 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004480
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004481 Example :
4482 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4483 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4484 # connections.
4485 backend dynamic
4486 fullconn 10000
4487 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4488 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4489
4490 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4491
4492
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004493grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004494 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004496 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004497 Arguments :
4498 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4499 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4500 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4501
4502 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4503 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004504 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004505 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4506
4507 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4508 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4509 simplify it.
4510
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004511
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004512hash-balance-factor <factor>
4513 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4515 yes | no | no | yes
4516 Arguments :
4517 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4518 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004519 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004520
4521 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4522 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4523 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4524 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4525 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4526 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4527 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4528
4529 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4530 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4531 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4532 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4533 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4534
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004535 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4536 consistent hashing mechanism.
4537
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004538 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4539
4540
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004541hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004542 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4544 yes | no | yes | yes
4545 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004546 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4547 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004548
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004549 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4550 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4551 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4552 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4553 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4554 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4555 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4556 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4557 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4558 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004559
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004560 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4561 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4562 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4563 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4564 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4565 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4566 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4567 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4568 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4569 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4570 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4571 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4572 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004573 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4574 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004575
4576 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4577
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004578 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004579 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4580 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4581 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004582 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4583 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4584 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004585
4586 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4587 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004588 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4589 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4590 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4591 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4592
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004593 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4594 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4595 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4596 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4597 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4598 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4599 parameter.
4600
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004601 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4602 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4603 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4604 used on strings.
4605
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004606 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4607
4608 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4609 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4610 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4611 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4612 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4613 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4614 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4615 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4616 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4617 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4618 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4619 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004620
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004621 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4622 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4623 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004624
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004625 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004626
4627
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004628http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4629 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4630 ones).
4631
4632 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4633 no | yes | yes | yes
4634
4635 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4636 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4637 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4638 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4639 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4640 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4641
4642 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4643 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4644 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4645
4646 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4647 below.
4648
4649 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4650 instance.
4651
4652 Example:
4653 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4654 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4655 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4656
4657http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4658
4659 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4660 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4661 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4662 example, or to pass some internal information.
4663 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4664 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4665 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4666
4667http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4668
4669 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4670 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4671
4672http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4673
4674 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4675
4676http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4677 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4678
4679 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4680
4681 Example:
4682 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4683
4684 # applied to:
4685 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4686
4687 # outputs:
4688 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4689
4690 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4691
4692http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4693 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4694
4695 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4696
4697 Example:
4698 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4699
4700 # applied to:
4701 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4702
4703 # outputs:
4704 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4705
4706http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4707
4708 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4709 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4710 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4711
4712http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4713 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4714
4715 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4716 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4717 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4718 fallback.
4719
4720 Example:
4721 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4722 http-response set-status 431
4723 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4724 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4725
4726http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4727
4728 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4729 inline.
4730
4731 Arguments:
4732 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4733 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4734 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4735 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4736 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4737 (request and response)
4738 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4739 processing
4740 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4741 processing
4742 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4743 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4744 and '_'.
4745
4746 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4747 followed by some converters.
4748
4749 Example:
4750 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4751
4752http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4753
4754 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4755 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4756 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4757 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4758 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004759 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004760 processing.
4761
4762 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4763 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004764 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004765 rules evaluation.
4766
4767http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4768
4769 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4770 details about <var-name>.
4771
4772 Example:
4773 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4774
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004775
4776http-check comment <string>
4777 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4778 it fails.
4779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4780 yes | no | yes | yes
4781
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004782 Arguments :
4783 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4784 rule fails.
4785
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004786 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4787 user-friendly error reporting.
4788
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004789 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004790 "http-check expect".
4791
4792
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004793http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4794 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004795 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004796 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4798 yes | no | yes | yes
4799
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004800 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004801 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4802
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004803 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004804 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004805
4806 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4807 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4808 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4809 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4810
4811 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4812
4813 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4814
4815 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4816
4817 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4818
4819 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4820
4821 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4822 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4823 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4824 is used.
4825
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004826 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4827 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4828 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4829 haproxy -vv.
4830
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004831 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4832
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004833 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4834 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4835 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4836 different ports or with different servers.
4837
4838 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4839 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4840 the port with a "http-check connect".
4841
4842 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4843 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4844 do.
4845
4846 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4847 unset-var or comment rules.
4848
4849 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004850 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4851 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4852 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4853 option httpchk
4854
4855 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004856 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004857 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004858 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004859 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004860 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004861
4862 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4863
4864 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004865
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004866
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004867http-check disable-on-404
4868 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004870 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004871 Arguments : none
4872
4873 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4874 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4875 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4876 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4877 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4878 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4879 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4880 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004881 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4882 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4883 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4884
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004885 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004886
4887
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004888http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004889 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4890 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4891 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004892 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004894 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004895
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004896 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004897 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4898
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004899 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4900 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4901 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4902 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4903 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4904 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4905 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4906 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4907 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4908 result is always conclusive.
4909
4910 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4911 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4912 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004913 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4914 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4915 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4916 example 404 with disable-on-404
4917 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4918 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4919 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004920
4921 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4922 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004923 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4924 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4925 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4926 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4927 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4928 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004929
4930 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4931 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004932 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4933 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4934 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4935 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004936 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4937
4938 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4939 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4940 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4941 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4942
4943 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4944 informational message reported in logs if an error
4945 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4946 log-format string.
4947
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004948 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004949 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4950 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004951 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4952 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4953 details on the supported keywords.
4954
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004955 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4956 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4957 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4958 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004959
4960 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4961 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4962 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4963 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4964 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4965
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004966 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4967 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4968 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4969 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4970 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4971 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4972 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004973
4974 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004975 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004976 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4977 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4978 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4979 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4980
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004981 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4982 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004983 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4984 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4985 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4986 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4987 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4988 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4989 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4990 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004991 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4992 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4993 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4994 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4995 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4996 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4997 insensitive on the header names.
4998
4999 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5000 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5001 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5002 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5003 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5004 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005005
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005006 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005007 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005008 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5009 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5010 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5011 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5012 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005013 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005014 trace).
5015
5016 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005017 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005018 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5019 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5020 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5021 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5022 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005023 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005024
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005025 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5026 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5027 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5028 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5029 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5030 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5031
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005032 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
5033 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
5034 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5035 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5036 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5037 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5038 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5039 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5040
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005041 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5042 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5043 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5044 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5045 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005046
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005047 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5048 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5049
5050 Examples :
5051 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005052 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005053
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005054 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5055 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5056
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005057 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005058 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005059
5060 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005061 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005062
5063 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005064 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005065
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005066 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005067 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005068
5069
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005070http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005071 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5072 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005073 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5074 health checks.
5075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5076 yes | no | yes | yes
5077 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005078 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5079
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005080 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5081 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5082 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5083 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5084 to invent non-standard ones.
5085
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005086 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5087 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5088 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5089 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5090
5091 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5092 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5093 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5094 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005095
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005096 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005097 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005098 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005099 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5100 to add it.
5101
5102 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5103 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5104 to the log-format rules.
5105
5106 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5107 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5108 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005109
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005110 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5111 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5112 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5113 request.
5114
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005115 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5116 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5117 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005118 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5119 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5120 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5121 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005122 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005123 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005124 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5125
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005126 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5127 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005128 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5129 so, it will be ignored.
5130
5131 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5132 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5133 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5134 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5135 configured request authority.
5136
5137 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5138 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005139
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005140 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005141
5142
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005143http-check send-state
5144 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5146 yes | no | yes | yes
5147 Arguments : none
5148
5149 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5150 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5151 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5152 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5153 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5154
5155 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5156 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5157 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5158 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5159 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005160 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5161 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5162 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5163
5164 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5165 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5166 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5167
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005168 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5169 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5170 checked in multiple backends.
5171
5172 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5173 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5174
5175 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5176 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5177 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5178 one fails.
5179
5180 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5181 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5182 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5183
5184 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5185 server's queue.
5186
5187 Example of a header received by the application server :
5188 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5189 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5190
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005191 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5192 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005193
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005194
5195http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005196 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005197 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5198 yes | no | yes | yes
5199
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005200 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005201 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5202 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5203 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5204 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5205 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5206 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5207 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5208 and '-'.
5209
5210 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5211
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005212 Examples :
5213 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005214
5215
5216http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005217 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5219 yes | no | yes | yes
5220
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005221 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005222 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5223 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5224 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5225 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5226 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5227 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5228 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5229 and '-'.
5230
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005231 Examples :
5232 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005233
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005234
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005235http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5236 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5237 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5238 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5239 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5241 yes | yes | yes | yes
5242 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005243 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005244 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005245 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5246 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005247
5248 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5249 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5250 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5251 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5252
5253 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5254 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5255 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5256 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5257
5258 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5259 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5260 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5261 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5262 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5263 chroot is performed.
5264
5265 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5266 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5267 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5268 considered.
5269
5270 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5271 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5272 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5273 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5274 considered as a raw string.
5275
5276 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5277 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5278 "content-type".
5279
5280 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5281 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5282 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5283 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5284 evaluated as a log-format string.
5285
5286 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5287 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5288 argument to "content-type".
5289
5290 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5291 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5292 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5293 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5294
5295 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5296 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5297 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5298 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5299 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5300 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5301 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5302 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5303
5304 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5305 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5306 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5307
5308 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5309 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5310
5311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005312http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005313 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5314
5315 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5316 no | yes | yes | yes
5317
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005318 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5319 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5320 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5321 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5322 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005324 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5325 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005327 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005329 Example:
5330 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5331 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5332 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005334 http-request allow if nagios
5335 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5336 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5337 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005338
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005339 Example:
5340 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5341 acl add path /addacl
5342 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005343
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005344 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005346 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5347 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005349 Example:
5350 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5351 acl setmap path /setmap
5352 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005354 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005356 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5357 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005359 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5360 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005362http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005364 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5365 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5366 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5367 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5368 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5369 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5370 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5371 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005373http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005375 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5376 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5377 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5378 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5379 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5380 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5381 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5382 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005384http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005386 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5387 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005388
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005390http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005391
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005392 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5393 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5394 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5395 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5396 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005397
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005398 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5399 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5400 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5401 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5402 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5403 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5404 instead.
5405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005406 Example:
5407 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5408 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005409
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005410http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005411
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005412 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005413
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005414http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5415 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005417 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5418 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5419 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5420 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5421 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5422 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5423 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5424 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5425 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005427 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5428 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5429 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005430 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5431
5432 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5433 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5434 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5435 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005436
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005437http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005438
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005439 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5440 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5441 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5442 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5443 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5444 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005446http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005447
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005448 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005449
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005450http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005451
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005452 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5453 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5454 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5455 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5456 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5457 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005458
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005459http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5460http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5461 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5462 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5463 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5464 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005465
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005466 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5467 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5468 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005469 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005470 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5471 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5472 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005473 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005474 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005475
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005476http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5477 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5478 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5479 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5480
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005481http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5482
5483 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5484 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5485 pointed by <resolvers>.
5486 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5487 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5488 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5489 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5490 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5491 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5492 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5493 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5494 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5495 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5496 to 0.0.0.0.
5497
5498 Example:
5499 resolvers mydns
5500 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5501 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5502 timeout retry 1s
5503 hold valid 10s
5504 hold nx 3s
5505 hold other 3s
5506 hold obsolete 0s
5507 accepted_payload_size 8192
5508
5509 frontend fe
5510 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5511 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5512 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5513
5514 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5515 # which mean DNS resolution error
5516 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5517
5518 default_backend be
5519
5520 backend b_503
5521 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5522 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5523 # 503 error page to end users
5524
5525 backend be
5526 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5527 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5528 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5529 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5530 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5531
5532 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5533 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5534
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005535http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5536
5537 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5538 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5539 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5540 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005541 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5542 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005543
5544 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005546http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005547
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005548 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5549 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5550 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5551 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5552 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005553
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005554http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005556 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5557 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5558 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5559 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005561http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5562 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005563
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005564 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005565 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5566 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5567 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5568 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5569 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005570
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005571 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5572 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5573 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5574 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5575 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005576
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005577 Example:
5578 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5579
5580 # applied to:
5581 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5582
5583 # outputs:
5584 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5585
5586 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005587
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005588 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5589
5590 # applied to:
5591 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005592
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005593 # outputs:
5594 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005595
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005596http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5597 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5598
5599 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5600 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005601 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5602 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5603 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005604
5605 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5606 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5607 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5608
5609 Example:
5610 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5611 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5612
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005613 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5614 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5615 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5616 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5617
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005618http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5619 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5620
5621 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5622 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5623 query-string are replaced.
5624
5625 Example:
5626 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5627 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5628
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005629http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5630 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5631
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005632 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5633 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5634 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5635 against.
5636
5637 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5638 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5639 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005640
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005641 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5642 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5643 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5644 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5645 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5646 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5647 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5648 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5649 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005650 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5651 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005652
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005653 Example:
5654 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5655 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005656
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005657 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5658 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005660http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5661 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005662
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005663 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5664 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5665 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5666 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005667
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005668 Example:
5669 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005670
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005671 # applied to:
5672 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005673
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005674 # outputs:
5675 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005676
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005677http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5678 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5679 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005680 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005681 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5682
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005683 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005684 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5685 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005686 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005687 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005688 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005689 are followed to create the response :
5690
5691 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5692 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5693 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5694 ignored.
5695
5696 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5697 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005698 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005699 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5700 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005701
5702 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5703 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5704 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005705 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005706 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005707
5708 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5709 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5710 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005711 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005712 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5713 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005714
5715 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5716 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5717 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5718 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5719 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5720 as a raw content.
5721
5722 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5723 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5724 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5725 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5726 considered as a raw string.
5727
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005728 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005729 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5730 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5731 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5732
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005733 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5734 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005735 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005736
5737 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5738
5739 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005740 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005741 if { path /ping }
5742
5743 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5744 if { path /favicon.ico }
5745
5746 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5747 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5748 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5749
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005750http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5751http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005752
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005753 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5754 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5755 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005756
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005757http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5758 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005759
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005760 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5761 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5762 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5763 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005764
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005765http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005766
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005767 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5768 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5769 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5770 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5771 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005772
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005773 Arguments:
5774 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5775 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005776
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005777 Example:
5778 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5779 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005780
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005781 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5782 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005783
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005784http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005785
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005786 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5787 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5788 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005789
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005790 Arguments:
5791 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5792 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005794 Example:
5795 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5796 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005797
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005798 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5799 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5800 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005802http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005803
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005804 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5805 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5806 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5807 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5808 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005809
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005810 Example:
5811 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5812 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5813 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5814 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5815 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5816 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5817 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5818 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5819 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005820
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005821http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005822
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005823 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5824 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5825 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5826 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5827 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005828
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005829http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5830 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005831
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005832 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5833 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5834 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5835 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5836 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5837 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5838 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5839 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5840 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005841
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005842http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005843
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005844 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5845 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5846 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5847 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5848 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5849 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5850 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005851
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005852http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005853
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005854 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5855 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5856 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005857
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005858http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005859
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005860 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5861 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5862 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5863 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5864 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5865 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5866 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5867 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005868
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005869http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005870
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005871 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5872 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5873 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5874 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5875 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5876 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005877
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005878 Example :
5879 # prepend the host name before the path
5880 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005881
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005882http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5883
5884 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
5885 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
5886 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
5887
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005888http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005889
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005890 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5891 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5892 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5893 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5894 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005895
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005896http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005897
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005898 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5899 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5900 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5901 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5902 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5903 values have higher priority.
5904 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5905 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5906 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5907 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5908 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005909
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005910http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005911
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005912 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5913 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5914 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5915 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5916 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5917 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5918 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005919
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005920 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005921
5922 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005923 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5924 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005925
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005926http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5927 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5928 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5929 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005930 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5931 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005932
5933 Arguments :
5934 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5935 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005936
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005937 See also "option forwardfor".
5938
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005939 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005940 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5941 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5942
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005943 # After the masking this will track connections
5944 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5945 http-request track-sc0 src
5946
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005947 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5948 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5949
5950http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5951
5952 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5953 expression.
5954
5955 Arguments:
5956 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5957 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005958
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005959 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005960 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5961 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5962
5963 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5964 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5965 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5966
5967http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5968
5969 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5970 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5971 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5972 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5973 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5974 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5975 information from the request.
5976
5977 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5978
5979http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5980
5981 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5982 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5983 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5984 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5985 path and the query string.
5986 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5987
5988http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5989
5990 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5991 inline.
5992
5993 Arguments:
5994 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5995 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5996 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5997 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5998 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5999 (request and response)
6000 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6001 processing
6002 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6003 processing
6004 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6005 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6006 and '_'.
6007
6008 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6009 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006010
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006011 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006012 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006014http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6015 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006016
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006017 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6018 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6019 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6020 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6021 agent name must be used.
6022
6023 Arguments:
6024 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6025
6026 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6027 configuration.
6028
6029http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6030
6031 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6032 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6033 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6034 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6035 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6036 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6037 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6038 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6039 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6040 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6041 action.
6042 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6043 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6044 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6045 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6046 you fully understand how it works.
6047
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006048http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6049
6050 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6051 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6052 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6053 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6054 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006055 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006056 processing.
6057
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006058 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006059 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6060 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6061 rules evaluation.
6062
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006063http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6064http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6065 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6066 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6067 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6068 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006069
6070 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6071 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6072 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006073 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6074 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6075 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6076 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6077 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6078 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6079 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6080 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6081 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6082 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006083 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006084 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6085 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6086 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6087 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6088 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006089
6090http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6091http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6092http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6093
6094 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6095 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6096 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6097 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
6098 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
6099 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6100 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6101 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6102 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6103 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6104 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6105 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6106
6107 Arguments :
6108 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6109 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6110 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6111 select which table entry to update the counters.
6112
6113 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6114 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6115 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6116 that table until the session ends.
6117
6118 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6119 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6120 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6121 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6122 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6123 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6124 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6125 useful information.
6126
6127 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6128 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6129 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6130 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6131 checks that make use of it.
6132
6133http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6134
6135 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006136
6137 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006138 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006139
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006140http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6141
6142 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6143 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6144 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6145 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6146 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6147 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6148
6149 Arguments :
6150 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6151
6152 Example:
6153 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6154
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006155http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006157 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6158 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6159 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006160
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006161
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006162http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006163 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6164
6165 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6166 no | yes | yes | yes
6167
6168 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6169 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6170 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6171 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6172 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6173 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006175 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6176 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006177
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006178 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006179
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006180 Example:
6181 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006182
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006183 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006184
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006185 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6186 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006187
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006188 Example:
6189 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006190
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006191 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006193 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6194 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006196 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6197 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006198
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006199http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006200
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006201 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6202 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6203 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6204 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6205 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6206 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6207 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6208 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006210http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006211
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006212 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6213 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6214 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6215 example, or to pass some internal information.
6216 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6217 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6218 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006219
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006220http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006221
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006222 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6223 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006224
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006225http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006226
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006227 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006228
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006229http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006230
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006231 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6232 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6233 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6234 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6235 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6236 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6237 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006238
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006239 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6240 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6241 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6242 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6243 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006244
6245 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6246 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6247 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6248 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006249
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006250http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006251
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006252 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6253 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6254 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6255 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6256 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6257 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006258
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006259http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006260
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006261 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006262
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006263http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006264
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006265 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6266 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6267 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6268 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6269 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6270 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006271
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006272http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6273http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6274 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6275 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6276 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6277 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006278
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006279 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6280 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6281 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006282 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006283 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6284 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6285 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006286 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006287 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006288
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006289http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006290
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006291 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6292 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6293 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6294 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6295 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6296 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006297
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006298http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6299 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006300
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006301 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6302 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006303
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006304 Example:
6305 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006306
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006307 # applied to:
6308 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006309
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006310 # outputs:
6311 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006312
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006313 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006314
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006315http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6316 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006317
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006318 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006319 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006320
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006321 Example:
6322 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006323
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006324 # applied to:
6325 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006326
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006327 # outputs:
6328 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006329
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006330http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6331 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6332 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006333 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006334 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6335
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006336 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006337 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6338 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006339 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006340 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006341 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006342 are followed to create the response :
6343
6344 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6345 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6346 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6347 ignored.
6348
6349 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6350 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006351 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006352 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6353 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006354
6355 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6356 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6357 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006358 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006359 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006360
6361 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6362 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6363 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006364 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006365 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6366 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006367
6368 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6369 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6370 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6371 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6372 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6373 as a raw content.
6374
6375 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6376 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6377 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6378 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6379 considered as a raw string.
6380
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006381 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6382 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6383 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6384 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6385
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006386 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6387 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006388 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006389
6390 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6391
6392 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006393 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006394 if { status eq 404 }
6395
6396 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6397 string "This is the end !" \
6398 if { status eq 500 }
6399
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006400http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6401http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006402
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006403 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6404 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6405 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006406
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006407http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6408 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006409
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006410 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6411 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6412 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6413 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006414
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006415http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006416
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006417 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6418 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6419 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6420 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6421 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006422
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006423 Arguments:
6424 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006425
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006426 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6427 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006428
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006429http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006430
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006431 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6432 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6433 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006434
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006435http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6436
6437 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6438 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6439 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6440 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6441 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6442
6443http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6444
6445 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6446 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6447 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6448 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6449 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6450 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6451 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6452 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6453 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6454
6455http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6456
6457 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6458 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6459 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6460 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6461 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6462 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6463 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6464
6465http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6466
6467 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6468 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6469 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6470 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6471 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6472 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6473 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6474 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6475
6476http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6477 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6478
6479 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6480 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6481 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6482 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006483
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006484 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006485 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6486 http-response set-status 431
6487 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6488 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006489
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006490http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006491
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006492 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6493 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6494 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6495 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6496 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6497 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6498 based on some information from the request.
6499
6500 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6501
6502http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6503
6504 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6505 inline.
6506
6507 Arguments:
6508 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6509 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6510 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6511 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6512 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6513 (request and response)
6514 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6515 processing
6516 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6517 processing
6518 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6519 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6520 and '_'.
6521
6522 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6523 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006524
6525 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006526 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006527
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006528http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006529
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006530 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6531 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6532 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6533 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6534 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6535 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6536 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6537 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6538 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6539 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6540 action.
6541 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6542 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6543 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6544 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6545 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006546
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006547http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6548
6549 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6550 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6551 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6552 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6553 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006554 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006555 processing.
6556
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006557 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006558 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006559 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006560 rules evaluation.
6561
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006562http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6563http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6564http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006565
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006566 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6567 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6568 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6569 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6570 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6571 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6572
6573http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6574
6575 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6576 about <var-name>.
6577
6578 Example:
6579 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6580
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006581
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006582http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6583 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6584
6585 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6586 yes | no | yes | yes
6587
6588 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006589 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6590 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6591 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006592
6593 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6594
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006595 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6596 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6597 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6598 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6599 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6600 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6601 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6602 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6603 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6604 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006605
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006606 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6607 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6608 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6609 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6610 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6611 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6612 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006613 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6614 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6615 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6616 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6617 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6618 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006619
6620 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6621 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6622 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6623 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6624 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6625 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6626 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6627 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006628 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006629 downsides of rare connection failures.
6630
6631 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6632 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6633 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6634 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6635 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6636 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006637 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006638 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6639 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6640 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6641 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6642 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6643
6644 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006645 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6646 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6647 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006648
6649 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006650 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006651
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006652 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6653 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006654
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006655 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006656
6657 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6658 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6659 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6660
6661 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6662
6663
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006664http-send-name-header [<header>]
6665 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006666 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6667 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006668 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006669 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6670
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006671 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6672 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6673 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6674 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6675 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6676 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6677 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6678 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6679 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6680 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6681 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6682 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6683 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6684 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6685 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6686 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006687
6688 See also : "server"
6689
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006690id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006691 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6693 no | yes | yes | yes
6694 Arguments : none
6695
6696 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6697 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6698 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006699
6700
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006701ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6702 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6703 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006704 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006705
6706 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6707 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6708 and running).
6709
6710 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6711 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6712 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006713 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006714 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6715
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006716 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6717 "unless" condition is met.
6718
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006719 Example:
6720 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6721 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6722 ignore-persist if url_static
6723
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006724 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6725
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006726load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6727 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6728 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6729 yes | no | yes | yes
6730
6731 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6732 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6733 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006734 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006735 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6736 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6737 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6738 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6739
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006740 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006741 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006742 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006743
6744 Arguments:
6745 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6746 named "server-state-file".
6747
6748 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6749 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6750 name is used as a file name.
6751
6752 none don't load any stat for this backend
6753
6754 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006755 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6756 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6757 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006758 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006759 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006760
6761 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6762 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6763
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006764 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006765
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006766 global
6767 stats socket /tmp/socket
6768 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006769
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006770 defaults
6771 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006772
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006773 backend bk
6774 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6775 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006776
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006777
6778 Then one can run :
6779
6780 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6781
6782 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6783
6784 1
6785 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6786 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6787 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6788
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006789 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006790
6791 global
6792 stats socket /tmp/socket
6793 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6794
6795 defaults
6796 load-server-state-from-file local
6797
6798 backend bk
6799 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6800 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6801
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006802
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006803 Then one can run :
6804
6805 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6806
6807 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6808
6809 1
6810 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6811 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6812 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6813
6814 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6815 "show servers state"
6816
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006817
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006818log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006819log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6820 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006821no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006822 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6824 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006825
6826 Prefix :
6827 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6828 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6829 prefix does not allow arguments.
6830
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006831 Arguments :
6832 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6833 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6834 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6835 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6836 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6837 parameter.
6838
6839 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6840 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6841
6842 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6843 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6844 standard syslog port).
6845
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006846 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6847 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6848 standard syslog port).
6849
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006850 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6851 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6852 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006853 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006854
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006855 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6856 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6857 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6858 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6859 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6860 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6861 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6862 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6863 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6864 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6865 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6866 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6867 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6868 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6869 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6870 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006871 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6872 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006873
6874 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6875 and "fd@2", see above.
6876
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006877 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6878 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6879 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6880 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6881 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6882 having the logs instantly available.
6883
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006884 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6885 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006886
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006887 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6888 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6889 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6890 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6891 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6892 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6893 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6894 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6895 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6896 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006897 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006898
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006899 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6900 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6901 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6902 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6903 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6904
6905 <sample_size>
6906 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6907 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6908 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6909 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6910 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6911
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006912 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6913 one of the following :
6914
6915 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6916 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6917
6918 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6919 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6920
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006921 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
6922 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
6923 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6924 designed to be used with a local log server.
6925
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006926 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6927 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6928 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6929 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6930 systemd logger consumes.
6931
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006932 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6933 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
6934 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
6935 used with a local log server.
6936
6937 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
6938 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6939 designed to be used with a local log server.
6940
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006941 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6942 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6943 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6944 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6945
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006946 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6947
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006948 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6949 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6950 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6951
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006952 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6953 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6954 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6955 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006956
6957 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6958 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6959 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006960 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6961 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6962 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6963 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6964 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006965
6966 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6967
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006968 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6969 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6970 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006971
6972 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6973 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6974 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6975 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6976
6977 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6978 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006979
6980 Example :
6981 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006982 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6983 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6984 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006985 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6986 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006987 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006988
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006989
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006990log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006991 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6992 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6993 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006994
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006995 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6996 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6997 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6998 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6999 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007000
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007001 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7002 "option httplog" directives.
7003
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007004log-format-sd <string>
7005 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7006 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7007 yes | yes | yes | no
7008
7009 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7010 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7011 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7012 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7013 which covers the log format string in depth.
7014
7015 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7016 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7017
7018 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7019 log format to "rfc5424".
7020
7021 Example :
7022 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7023
7024
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007025log-tag <string>
7026 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7027 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7028 yes | yes | yes | yes
7029
7030 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7031 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7032 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7033 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7034 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7035 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7036 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7037 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7038 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007039
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007040max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7041 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7042 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7043 yes | no | yes | yes
7044
7045 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7046 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7047 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7048 servers.
7049
7050 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7051 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7052 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7053 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7054 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007055 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007056 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7057 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7058 picking a different server.
7059
7060 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7061 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7062 even if they have to be queued.
7063
7064 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7065 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7066
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007067max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7068 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7069 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7070 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007071
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007072maxconn <conns>
7073 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7075 yes | yes | yes | no
7076 Arguments :
7077 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7078 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7079 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7080 closes.
7081
7082 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7083 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7084 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7085 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007086 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7087 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7088 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7089 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007090
7091 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7092 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7093 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7094
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007095 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7096 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007097
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007098 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7099
7100
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007101mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007102 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7104 yes | yes | yes | yes
7105 Arguments :
7106 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7107 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7108 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7109 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7110
7111 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7112 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7113 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7114 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7115 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7116
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007117 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7118 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7119 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007120
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007121 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007122 defaults http_instances
7123 mode http
7124
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007125
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007126monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007127 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7129 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007130 Arguments :
7131 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7132 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007133 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007134 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7135 backend and its backup.
7136
7137 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7138 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7139 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7140 servers in a list of backends.
7141
7142 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7143 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7144 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7145 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7146 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7147 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7148 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007149 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7150 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007151
7152 Example:
7153 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007154 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007155 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7156 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7157 monitor-uri /site_alive
7158 monitor fail if site_dead
7159
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007160 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007161
7162
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007163monitor-uri <uri>
7164 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7166 yes | yes | yes | no
7167 Arguments :
7168 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7169 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7170
7171 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7172 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7173 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7174 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7175 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7176 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7177 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7178 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7179
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007180 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007181 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7182 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7183 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7184 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7185 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7186 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007187
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007188 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7189 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7190 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7191 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7192
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007193 Example :
7194 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7195 frontend www
7196 mode http
7197 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7198
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007199 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007200
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007201
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007202option abortonclose
7203no option abortonclose
7204 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7206 yes | no | yes | yes
7207 Arguments : none
7208
7209 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7210 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7211 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7212 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007213 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007214 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7215 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7216 encountered while delivering the response.
7217
7218 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7219 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7220 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7221 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7222 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7223 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007224 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007225 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007226 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007227 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7228 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7229 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7230
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007231 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7232 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007233 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7234 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7235 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7236 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7237 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7238 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007239 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007240
7241 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7242 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7243
7244 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7245
7246
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007247option accept-invalid-http-request
7248no option accept-invalid-http-request
7249 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7251 yes | yes | yes | no
7252 Arguments : none
7253
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007254 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007255 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007256 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007257 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7258 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7259 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7260 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7261 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007262 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7263 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7264 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7265 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007266 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007267 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007268 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7269 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7270 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007271
7272 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7273 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7274 been confirmed.
7275
7276 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7277 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007278 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7279 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007280 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7281
7282 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7283 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7284
7285 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7286 stats socket.
7287
7288
7289option accept-invalid-http-response
7290no option accept-invalid-http-response
7291 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7293 yes | no | yes | yes
7294 Arguments : none
7295
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007296 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007297 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007298 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007299 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7300 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7301 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7302 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7303 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007304 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7305 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7306 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007307
7308 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7309 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7310 been confirmed.
7311
7312 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7313 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7314 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7315 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7316
7317 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7318 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7319
7320 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7321 stats socket.
7322
7323
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007324option allbackups
7325no option allbackups
7326 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7328 yes | no | yes | yes
7329 Arguments : none
7330
7331 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7332 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7333 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7334 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7335 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7336 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7337 order between the backup servers anymore.
7338
7339 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7340 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7341
7342 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7343 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7344
7345
7346option checkcache
7347no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007348 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7350 yes | no | yes | yes
7351 Arguments : none
7352
7353 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7354 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007355 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007356 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7357 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007358 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007359
7360 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007361 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007362 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007363 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7364 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007365 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007366 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007367 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7368 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007369 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007370 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7371 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007372 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007373 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7374 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7375 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7376 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7377 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7378 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7379 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7380 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7381 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7382
7383 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007384 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7385 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7386 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7387 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007388
7389 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7390 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007391 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007392 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007393
7394 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7395 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7396
7397
7398option clitcpka
7399no option clitcpka
7400 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7402 yes | yes | yes | no
7403 Arguments : none
7404
7405 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7406 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007407 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007408 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7409
7410 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7411 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7412 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7413 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7414
7415 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7416 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7417 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7418 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7419 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7420
7421 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7422
7423 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7424 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7425 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7426
7427 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7428 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7429
7430 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7431
7432
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007433option contstats
7434 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7436 yes | yes | yes | no
7437 Arguments : none
7438
7439 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7440 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7441 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7442 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007443 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7444 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7445 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7446 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7447 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007448
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007449option disable-h2-upgrade
7450no option disable-h2-upgrade
7451 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7452 connection.
7453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7454 yes | yes | yes | no
7455 Arguments : none
7456
7457 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7458 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7459 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7460 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7461 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7462 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7463 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7464 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7465
7466 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7467 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007468
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007469option dontlog-normal
7470no option dontlog-normal
7471 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7473 yes | yes | yes | no
7474 Arguments : none
7475
7476 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7477 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7478 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7479 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7480 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7481 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7482 logged.
7483
7484 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7485 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7486 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007488 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007489 logging.
7490
7491
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007492option dontlognull
7493no option dontlognull
7494 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7496 yes | yes | yes | no
7497 Arguments : none
7498
7499 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7500 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7501 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7502 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7503 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7504 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007505 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7506 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7507 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007508
7509 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007510 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007511 would not be logged.
7512
7513 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7514 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7515
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007516 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007517 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007518
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007519
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007520option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007521 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7523 yes | yes | yes | yes
7524 Arguments :
7525 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7526 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007527 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007528 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007529
7530 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7531 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7532 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7533 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7534 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7535 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7536 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007537 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7538 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7539 possible that the client has already brought one.
7540
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007541 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007542 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007543 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007544 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007545 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007546 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007547
7548 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7549 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7550 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7551 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7552 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7553 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7554 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7555
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007556 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7557 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7558 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7559 are under the control of the end-user.
7560
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007561 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007562 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7563 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007564 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7565 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7566 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007567
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007568 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007569 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7570 frontend www
7571 mode http
7572 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7573
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007574 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7575 backend www
7576 mode http
7577 option forwardfor header X-Client
7578
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007579 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007580 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007581
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007582
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007583option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7584no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7585 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7587 yes | yes | yes | no
7588 Arguments : none
7589
7590 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7591 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7592 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7593 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7594 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7595 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7596 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7597
7598 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7599 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7600 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7601 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7602 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7603 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7604 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7605 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7606 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7607 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7608
7609 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7610
7611 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7612 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7613
7614 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7615 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7616
7617
7618option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7619no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7620 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7622 yes | no | yes | yes
7623 Arguments : none
7624
7625 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7626 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7627 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7628 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7629 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7630 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7631 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7632
7633 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7634 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7635 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7636 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7637 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7638 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7639 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7640 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7641 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7642 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7643
7644 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7645
7646 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7647 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7648
7649 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7650 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7651
7652
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007653option http-buffer-request
7654no option http-buffer-request
7655 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7657 yes | yes | yes | yes
7658 Arguments : none
7659
7660 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7661 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7662 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7663 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7664 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7665 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007666 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7667 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7668 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7669 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007670
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007671 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007672
7673
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007674option http-ignore-probes
7675no option http-ignore-probes
7676 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7678 yes | yes | yes | no
7679 Arguments : none
7680
7681 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7682 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7683 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7684 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7685 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7686 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7687 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7688 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7689 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007690 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7691 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007692 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7693
7694 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7695 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7696 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7697 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7698 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7699 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7700 are often the only way to detect them.
7701
7702 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7703 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7704
7705 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7706
7707
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007708option http-keep-alive
7709no option http-keep-alive
7710 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7712 yes | yes | yes | yes
7713 Arguments : none
7714
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007715 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7716 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007717 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7718 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007719 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7720 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7721 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007722
7723 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7724 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007725 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7726 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7727 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7728 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7729 situations where this option may be useful :
7730
7731 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007732 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007733
7734 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7735 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7736
7737 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7738 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7739 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7740 request.
7741
7742 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7743 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007744 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7745 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7746 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007747
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007748 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7749 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7750 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7751 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7752 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7753 not set.
7754
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007755 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7756 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7757 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007758
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007759 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007760 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007761 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007762
7763
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007764option http-no-delay
7765no option http-no-delay
7766 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7768 yes | yes | yes | yes
7769 Arguments : none
7770
7771 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7772 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7773 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7774 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7775 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7776 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7777 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7778 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7779 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7780 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7781 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7782 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7783 affected.
7784
7785 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7786 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7787 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7788 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7789 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7790 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7791 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7792 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7793 latency environments.
7794
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007795 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7796
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007797
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007798option http-pretend-keepalive
7799no option http-pretend-keepalive
7800 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007802 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007803 Arguments : none
7804
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007805 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007806 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7807 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7808 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7809 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7810 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7811 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7812 consider the response complete.
7813
7814 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7815 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7816 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7817 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007818 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007819 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7820
7821 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7822 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7823 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7824 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7825 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7826 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7827 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7828
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007829 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7830 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7831 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7832 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7833 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7834 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007835
7836 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7837 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7838
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007839 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007840 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007841
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007842
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007843option http-server-close
7844no option http-server-close
7845 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7847 yes | yes | yes | yes
7848 Arguments : none
7849
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007850 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7851 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7852 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7853 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007854 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7855 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7856 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7857 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7858 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7859 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7860 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7861 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7862 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7863 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7864 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007865
7866 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7867 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7868 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7869 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007870 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7871 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007872
7873 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7874 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007875 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7876 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7877 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007878
7879 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7880 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7881
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007882 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7883 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007884
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007885option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007886no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007887 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7889 yes | yes | yes | no
7890 Arguments : none
7891
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007892 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007893 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7894 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7895 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7896 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7897 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7898 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7899
7900 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7901 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007902 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7903 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7904 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007905
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007906 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7907 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7908 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7909 front of an existing proxy.
7910
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007911 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7912
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007913 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007914
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007915option httpchk
7916option httpchk <uri>
7917option httpchk <method> <uri>
7918option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007919 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7921 yes | no | yes | yes
7922 Arguments :
7923 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7924 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7925 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7926 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7927 ones.
7928
7929 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7930 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7931 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7932
7933 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7934 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7935 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007936 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007937
7938 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7939 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7940 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7941 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7942 the lack of any response.
7943
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007944 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7945 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7946 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7947 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7948
7949 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7950 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7951 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007952
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007953 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7954 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007955 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007956 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007957 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007958
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007959 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7960 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7961 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7962 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7963
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007964 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007965 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7966 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7967 backend https_relay
7968 mode tcp
7969 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7970 http-check send hdr Host www
7971 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007972
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007973 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7974 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7975 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007976
7977
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007978option httpclose
7979no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007980 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7982 yes | yes | yes | yes
7983 Arguments : none
7984
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007985 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7986 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7987 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7988 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007989 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007990
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007991 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7992 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007993 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007994 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7995 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007996
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007997 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7998 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7999 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008000
8001 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8002 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008003 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8004 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8005 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008006
8007 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8008 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8009
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008010 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008011
8012
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008013option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008014 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008016 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008017 Arguments :
8018 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8019 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8020 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008021 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008022 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008023
8024 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8025 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8026 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8027 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8028 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8029 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8030 ports.
8031
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008032 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8033 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008034
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008035 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008037 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008038
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008039
8040option http_proxy
8041no option http_proxy
8042 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8044 yes | yes | yes | yes
8045 Arguments : none
8046
8047 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8048 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8049 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8050 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8051 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8052
8053 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8054 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008055 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8056 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008057
8058 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8059 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8060
8061 Example :
8062 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8063 backend direct_forward
8064 option httpclose
8065 option http_proxy
8066
8067 See also : "option httpclose"
8068
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008069
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008070option independent-streams
8071no option independent-streams
8072 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8074 yes | yes | yes | yes
8075 Arguments : none
8076
8077 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8078 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8079 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8080 receive data or not.
8081
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008082 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008083 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8084 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8085 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8086 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8087 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8088 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8089 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8090 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8091 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8092 socket buffers.
8093
8094 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8095 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8096 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8097 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8098 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8099
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008100 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008101
8102
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008103option ldap-check
8104 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8106 yes | no | yes | yes
8107 Arguments : none
8108
8109 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8110 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8111 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8112 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8113
8114 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8115 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8116
8117 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8118 configure it.
8119
8120 Example :
8121 option ldap-check
8122
8123 See also : "option httpchk"
8124
8125
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008126option external-check
8127 Use external processes for server health checks
8128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8129 yes | no | yes | yes
8130
8131 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8132 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8133 command".
8134
8135 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8136
8137 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8138
8139
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008140option log-health-checks
8141no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008142 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8144 yes | no | yes | yes
8145 Arguments : none
8146
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008147 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8148 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8149 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008150
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008151 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8152 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8153 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8154 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8155 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8156
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008157 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008158 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008159
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008160 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8161 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8162 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008163
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008164
8165option log-separate-errors
8166no option log-separate-errors
8167 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8169 yes | yes | yes | no
8170 Arguments : none
8171
8172 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8173 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8174 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8175 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8176 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8177 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8178 provides very important information.
8179
8180 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8181 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8182 error logs.
8183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008184 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008185 logging.
8186
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008187
8188option logasap
8189no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008190 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8192 yes | yes | yes | no
8193 Arguments : none
8194
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008195 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8196 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8197 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8198 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8199
8200 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8201 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8202 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8203 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8204 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008205 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008206 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8207 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8208 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8209 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008210 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008211
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008212 Examples :
8213 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8214 mode http
8215 option httplog
8216 option logasap
8217 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8218
8219 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8220 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8221 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8222 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008224 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008225 logging.
8226
8227
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008228option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008229 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8231 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008232 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008233 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8234 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008235 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8236 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008237
8238 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8239 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008240 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008241 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8242 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8243 in the MySQL table, like this :
8244
8245 USE mysql;
8246 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8247 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8248
8249 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008250 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008251 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8252 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8253 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8254 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8255 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8256 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8257 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8258
8259 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8260 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008261
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008262 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008263
8264 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8265 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8266 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8267 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008268 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8269 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008270
8271 See also: "option httpchk"
8272
8273
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008274option nolinger
8275no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008276 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8278 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008279 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008280
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008281 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008282 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8283 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8284 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8285 connections.
8286
8287 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8288 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8289 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8290 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8291 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8292 this too.
8293
8294 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8295 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8296 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8297
8298 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8299 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8300 for servers.
8301
8302 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8303 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8304
8305
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008306option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8307 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8309 yes | yes | yes | yes
8310 Arguments :
8311 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8312 matching <network>
8313 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8314 header name.
8315
8316 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8317 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8318 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8319 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8320 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8321 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8322 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8323 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8324 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8325 possible that the client has already brought one.
8326
8327 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8328 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8329 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8330 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8331 header and requires different one.
8332
8333 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8334 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8335 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8336 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8337 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8338 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8339 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8340
8341 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8342 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8343 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8344 both are defined.
8345
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008346 Examples :
8347 # Original Destination address
8348 frontend www
8349 mode http
8350 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8351
8352 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8353 backend www
8354 mode http
8355 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8356
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008357 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008358
8359
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008360option persist
8361no option persist
8362 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8363 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8364 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008365 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008366
8367 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8368 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8369 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8370 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8371 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8372 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8373 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8374 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8375 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8376 redirected to another valid server.
8377
8378 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8379 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8380
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008381 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008382
8383
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008384option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8385 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8387 yes | no | yes | yes
8388 Arguments :
8389 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8390 PostgreSQL server.
8391
8392 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8393 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8394 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8395 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8396
8397 See also: "option httpchk"
8398
8399
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008400option prefer-last-server
8401no option prefer-last-server
8402 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8403 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8404 yes | no | yes | yes
8405 Arguments : none
8406
8407 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8408 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8409 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8410 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8411 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8412 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8413 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8414 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8415 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008416 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8417 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008418 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8419 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8420 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008421 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8422 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8423 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008424
8425 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8426 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8427
8428 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8429
8430
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008431option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008432option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008433no option redispatch
8434 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8435 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8436 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008437 Arguments :
8438 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8439 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8440 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008441 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008442 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008443 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008444 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8445 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8446 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008448
8449 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8450 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8451 be able to access the service anymore.
8452
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008453 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8454 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008455
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008456 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8457 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8458 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8459 following order:
8460
8461 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8462
8463 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8464 list, or
8465
8466 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8467
8468 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8469 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8470
8471 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8472 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8473 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8474 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8475
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008476 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008477 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8478 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008479
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008480 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8481 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8482
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008483 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008484
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008485
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008486option redis-check
8487 Use redis health checks for server testing
8488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8489 yes | no | yes | yes
8490 Arguments : none
8491
8492 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8493 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8494 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8495 find the "+PONG" response message.
8496
8497 Example :
8498 option redis-check
8499
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008500 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008501
8502
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008503option smtpchk
8504option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8505 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8507 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008508 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008509 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008510 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008511 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8512
8513 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8514 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8515 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8516
8517 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8518 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8519 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8520 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8521 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8522 dead server.
8523
8524 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8525 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008526 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008527 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8528
8529 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8530 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8531 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8532 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008533 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008534
8535 Example :
8536 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8537
8538 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8539
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008540
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008541option socket-stats
8542no option socket-stats
8543
8544 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8546 yes | yes | yes | no
8547
8548 Arguments : none
8549
8550
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008551option splice-auto
8552no option splice-auto
8553 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8555 yes | yes | yes | yes
8556 Arguments : none
8557
8558 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8559 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008560 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008561 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008562 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008563 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8564 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8565 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8566 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8567
8568 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8569 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8570 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8571 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8572 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8573 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8574 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8575 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8576 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8577 keyword.
8578
8579 Example :
8580 option splice-auto
8581
8582 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8583 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8584
8585 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8586 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8587
8588
8589option splice-request
8590no option splice-request
8591 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8593 yes | yes | yes | yes
8594 Arguments : none
8595
8596 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008597 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008598 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8599 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8600 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8601 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8602
8603 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8604
8605 Example :
8606 option splice-request
8607
8608 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8609 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8610
8611 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8612 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8613
8614
8615option splice-response
8616no option splice-response
8617 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8619 yes | yes | yes | yes
8620 Arguments : none
8621
8622 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008623 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008624 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8625 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8626 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8627 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8628
8629 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8630
8631 Example :
8632 option splice-response
8633
8634 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8635 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8636
8637 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8638 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8639
8640
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008641option spop-check
8642 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8644 no | no | no | yes
8645 Arguments : none
8646
8647 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8648 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8649 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8650 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8651
8652 Example :
8653 option spop-check
8654
8655 See also : "option httpchk"
8656
8657
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008658option srvtcpka
8659no option srvtcpka
8660 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8662 yes | no | yes | yes
8663 Arguments : none
8664
8665 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8666 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008667 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008668 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8669
8670 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8671 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8672 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8673 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8674
8675 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8676 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8677 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8678 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8679 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8680
8681 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8682
8683 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8684 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8685 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8686
8687 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8688 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8689
8690 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8691
8692
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008693option ssl-hello-chk
8694 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8696 yes | no | yes | yes
8697 Arguments : none
8698
8699 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8700 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8701 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8702 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8703 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8704 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8705 hello message.
8706
8707 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8708 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8709 messages, which is appreciable.
8710
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008711 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8712 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8713 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008714
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008715 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8716
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008717
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008718option tcp-check
8719 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8720 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8721 yes | no | yes | yes
8722
8723 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8724 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8725
8726 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8727 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8728 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8729
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008730 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008731 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8732 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8733 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8734 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8735 only.
8736
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008737 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008738 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8739 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8740 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8741 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8742
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008743 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008744 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8745 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008746 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008747 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8748 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8749 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8750 the respective protocols.
8751 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008752 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008753
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008754 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008755
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008756 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8757 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8758 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8759 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008760
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008761 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8762 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8763 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008764
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008765
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008766 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008767 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008768 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008769 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008771 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008772 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008773 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008774
8775 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8776 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008777 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008778 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008779 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008780 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008781 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008782 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008783 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8784 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008785 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008786 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8787 tcp-check expect string +OK
8788
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008789 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008790 (send many headers before analyzing)
8791 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008792 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008793 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8794 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8795 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8796 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008797 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008798
8799
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008800 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008801
8802
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008803option tcp-smart-accept
8804no option tcp-smart-accept
8805 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8807 yes | yes | yes | no
8808 Arguments : none
8809
8810 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8811 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8812 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8813 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8814 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8815 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8816
8817 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8818 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8819 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8820 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8821
8822 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8823 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8824 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008825 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008826
8827 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8828 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8829 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8830
8831 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8832 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8833 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8834
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008835 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8836
8837
8838option tcp-smart-connect
8839no option tcp-smart-connect
8840 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8842 yes | no | yes | yes
8843 Arguments : none
8844
8845 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8846 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8847 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8848 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8849 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8850
8851 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8852 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8853 complex.
8854
8855 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8856 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8857 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8858
8859 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8860 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8861
8862 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8863
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008864
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008865option tcpka
8866 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8868 yes | yes | yes | yes
8869 Arguments : none
8870
8871 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8872 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008873 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008874 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8875
8876 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8877 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8878 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8879 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8880
8881 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8882 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8883 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8884 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8885 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8886
8887 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8888
8889 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8890 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8891 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8892 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8893 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8894 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8895 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8896 backends.
8897
8898 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8899
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008900
8901option tcplog
8902 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008904 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008905 Arguments : none
8906
8907 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8908 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8909 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8910 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8911 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8912 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8913 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8914 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8915
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008916 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8917
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008918 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008919
8920
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008921option transparent
8922no option transparent
8923 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008925 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008926 Arguments : none
8927
8928 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8929 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8930 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8931 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8932 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8933 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8934 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8935 appropriate server.
8936
8937 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8938 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8939
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008940 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008941 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008942
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008943
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008944external-check command <command>
8945 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8947 yes | no | yes | yes
8948
8949 Arguments :
8950 <command> is the external command to run
8951
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008952 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8953
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008954 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008955
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008956 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8957 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8958 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8959 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8960 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8961 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008962
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008963 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8964
8965 Environment variables :
8966 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8967 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8968
8969 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8970
8971 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8972
8973 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8974 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8975 for a UNIX socket).
8976
8977 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8978
8979 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8980
8981 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8982
8983 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8984
8985 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8986
8987 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8988 socket).
8989
8990 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8991 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8992
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008993 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8994
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008995 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8996 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8997 failed.
8998
8999 Example :
9000 external-check command /bin/true
9001
9002 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9003
9004
9005external-check path <path>
9006 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9008 yes | no | yes | yes
9009
9010 Arguments :
9011 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9012
9013 The default path is "".
9014
9015 Example :
9016 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9017
9018 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9019 "external-check command"
9020
9021
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009022persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009023persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009024 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9026 yes | no | yes | yes
9027 Arguments :
9028 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009029 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9030 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009031
9032 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9033 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009034 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009035 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9036 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9037 forwarded to this server.
9038
9039 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9040 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9041 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009042 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009043 a single "listen" section.
9044
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009045 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9046 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9047 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9048
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009049 Example :
9050 listen tse-farm
9051 bind :3389
9052 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9053 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9054 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9055 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9056 persist rdp-cookie
9057 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009058 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009059 balance rdp-cookie
9060 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9061 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9062
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009063 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9064 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009065
9066
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009067rate-limit sessions <rate>
9068 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9070 yes | yes | yes | no
9071 Arguments :
9072 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9073 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9074
9075 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9076 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9077 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9078 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9079 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9080 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9081
9082 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9083 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9084 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9085 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9086
9087 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9088 listen smtp
9089 mode tcp
9090 bind :25
9091 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009092 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009093
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009094 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9095 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9096 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009097
9098 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9099
9100
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009101redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9102redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9103redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009104 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9106 no | yes | yes | yes
9107
9108 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009109 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009110
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009111 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009112 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009113 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9114 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9115 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009116
9117 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9118 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9119 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9120 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9121 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009122 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9123 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9124 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9125 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009126
9127 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9128 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9129 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9130 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9131 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9132 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009133 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009134 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009135 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9136 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9137 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009138
9139 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009140 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9141 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9142 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009143 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009144 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9145 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9146 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9147 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009148
9149 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009150 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009151
9152 - "drop-query"
9153 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9154 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9155 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9156 with a location-type redirect.
9157
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009158 - "append-slash"
9159 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9160 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9161 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9162 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9163
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009164 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9165 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9166 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9167 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9168 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9169 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9170 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9171
9172 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9173 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9174 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9175 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9176 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9177 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9178 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009179
9180 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9181 acl clear dst_port 80
9182 acl secure dst_port 8080
9183 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009184 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009185 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009186 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9187
9188 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009189 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9190 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9191 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009192 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009193
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009194 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9195 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9196 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9197
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009198 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009199 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009200
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009201 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009202 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9203 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9204 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009206 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009207
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009208
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009209retries <value>
9210 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9211 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9212 yes | no | yes | yes
9213 Arguments :
9214 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9215 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9216 default value is 3.
9217
9218 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9219 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9220 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9221
9222 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009223 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9224 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009225
9226 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9227 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9228
9229 See also : "option redispatch"
9230
9231
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009232retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009233 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9234 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9235 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009236 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9237 yes | no | yes | yes
9238 Arguments :
9239 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9240 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9241 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9242 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9243
9244 none never retry
9245
9246 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9247 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9248
9249 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9250 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9251 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9252 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9253 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9254 processing the request.
9255
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009256 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9257 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9258 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9259 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9260 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9261 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9262 overflow attack for example).
9263
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009264 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9265 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9266 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9267 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9268 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9269 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9270 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9271 amplify denial of service attacks.
9272
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009273 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9274 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9275 considered to be safe to retry.
9276
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009277 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9278 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9279 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9280 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9281
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009282 all-retryable-errors
9283 retry request for any error that are considered
9284 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9285 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9286 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9287
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009288 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9289 not cumulative.
9290
9291 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9292 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9293 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9294 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9295
9296 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9297 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9298 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9299 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9300 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9301 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9302 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9303 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9304 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9305 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9306 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9307 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9308
9309 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9310 should not use this directive.
9311
9312 The default is "conn-failure".
9313
9314 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9315
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009316server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009317 Declare a server in a backend
9318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9319 no | no | yes | yes
9320 Arguments :
9321 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009322 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009323 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009324
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009325 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9326 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9327 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9328 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009329 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9330 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9331 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9332 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9333 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009334 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9335 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9336 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9337 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9338 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9339 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9340 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009341 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009342 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9343 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9344 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9345 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9346 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9347 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009348 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9349 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009350 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9351 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009352
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009353 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009354 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9355 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9356 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9357 adding this value to the client's port.
9358
9359 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9360 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009361 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009362
9363 Examples :
9364 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9365 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009366 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009367 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9368 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9369 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009370
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009371 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9372 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9373 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9374 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9375 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9376
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009377 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9378 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009379
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009380server-state-file-name [<file>]
9381 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9382 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9383 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9384 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9385 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9386 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9387
9388 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9389 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9390
9391 global
9392 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9393
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009394 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009395 load-server-state-from-file
9396
9397 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9398 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009399
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009400server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9401 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9402 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9404 no | no | yes | yes
9405
9406 Arguments:
9407 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9408
9409 <num | range>
9410 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9411 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9412 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9413 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9414
9415 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9416
9417 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9418
9419 <params*>
9420 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9421 keyword.
9422
9423 Examples:
9424 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9425 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9426 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9427
9428 # or
9429 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9430
9431 # would be equivalent to:
9432 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9433 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9434 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9435
9436
9437
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009438source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009439source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009440source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009441 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9443 yes | no | yes | yes
9444 Arguments :
9445 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9446 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009447
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009448 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009449 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9450 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9451 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9452 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9453 supported prefixes are :
9454 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9455 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9456 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009457 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009458 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9459 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009460
9461 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9462 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009463 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9464 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9465 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009466
9467 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9468 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9469 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9470 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9471 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9472 <addr>.
9473
9474 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9475 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9476 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9477 port.
9478
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009479 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9480 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9481 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9482 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009483 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009484 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9485 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9486 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9487 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9488 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9489 HTTP header.
9490
9491 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9492 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009493 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009494 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9495 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9496 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9497 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9498 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9499 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9500 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9501
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009502 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9503 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9504 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9505 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9506 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9507 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9508
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009509 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9510 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9511 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9512 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9513
9514 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9515 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9516 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9517 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9518 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9519 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9520
9521 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9522 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9523 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9524 there are two methods :
9525
9526 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9527 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9528 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9529 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9530 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9531 of the client ranges may be used.
9532
9533 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9534 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9535 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9536 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9537 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9538 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9539 same session.
9540
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009541 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9542 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9543 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009544 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009545
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009546 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9547
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009548 Examples :
9549 backend private
9550 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9551 source 192.168.1.200
9552
9553 backend transparent_ssl1
9554 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9555 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9556
9557 backend transparent_ssl2
9558 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9559 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9560 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9561
9562 backend transparent_ssl3
9563 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9564 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9565 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9566
9567 backend transparent_smtp
9568 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9569 # with Tproxy version 4.
9570 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9571
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009572 backend transparent_http
9573 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9574 # proxy.
9575 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009577 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009578 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9579
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009580
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009581srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9582 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9583 the connection on the server side.
9584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9585 yes | no | yes | yes
9586 Arguments :
9587 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9588
9589 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9590 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009591 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9592 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009593
9594 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9595
9596
9597srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9598 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9599 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9600 server side.
9601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9602 yes | no | yes | yes
9603 Arguments :
9604 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9605 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9606 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9607 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9608
9609 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9610 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009611 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9612 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009613
9614 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9615
9616
9617srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9618 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9620 yes | no | yes | yes
9621 Arguments :
9622 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9623 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9624 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9625 document.
9626
9627 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9628 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009629 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9630 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009631
9632 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9633
9634
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009635stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9636 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009638 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009639
9640 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9641 matched.
9642
9643 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9644 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9645
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009646 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9647 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009648 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009649
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009650 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9651 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9652 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9653 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009654
9655 Example :
9656 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9657 backend stats_localhost
9658 stats enable
9659 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9660
9661 Example :
9662 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9663 backend stats_auth
9664 stats enable
9665 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9666 stats admin if TRUE
9667
9668 Example :
9669 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9670 userlist stats-auth
9671 group admin users admin
9672 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9673 group readonly users haproxy
9674 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9675
9676 backend stats_auth
9677 stats enable
9678 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9679 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9680 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9681 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9682
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009683 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9684 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9685 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009686
9687
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009688stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9689 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009691 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009692 Arguments :
9693 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9694
9695 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9696
9697 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9698 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9699 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9700 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9701 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9702 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9703
9704 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9705 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9706 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009707 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009708
9709 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9710 report using "stats scope".
9711
9712 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9713 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9714 unobvious parameters.
9715
9716 Example :
9717 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9718 backend public_www
9719 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9720 stats enable
9721 stats hide-version
9722 stats scope .
9723 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009724 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009725 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9726 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9727
9728 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9729 backend private_monitoring
9730 stats enable
9731 stats uri /admin?stats
9732 stats refresh 5s
9733
9734 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9735
9736
9737stats enable
9738 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009740 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009741 Arguments : none
9742
9743 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9744 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9745 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9746 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9747 - stats auth : no authentication
9748 - stats scope : no restriction
9749
9750 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9751 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9752 unobvious parameters.
9753
9754 Example :
9755 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9756 backend public_www
9757 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9758 stats enable
9759 stats hide-version
9760 stats scope .
9761 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009762 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009763 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9764 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9765
9766 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9767 backend private_monitoring
9768 stats enable
9769 stats uri /admin?stats
9770 stats refresh 5s
9771
9772 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9773
9774
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009775stats hide-version
9776 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009778 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009779 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009780
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009781 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9782 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9783 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9784 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9785 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9786 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009787
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009788 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9789 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9790 unobvious parameters.
9791
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009792 Example :
9793 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9794 backend public_www
9795 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009796 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009797 stats hide-version
9798 stats scope .
9799 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009800 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009801 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9802 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009803
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009804 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9805 backend private_monitoring
9806 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009807 stats uri /admin?stats
9808 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009809
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009810 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009811
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009812
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009813stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9814 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9815 Access control for statistics
9816
9817 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9818 no | no | yes | yes
9819
9820 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9821 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9822 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9823 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9824 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9825 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9826
9827 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9828 instance.
9829
9830 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9831 about ACL usage.
9832
9833
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009834stats realm <realm>
9835 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009837 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009838 Arguments :
9839 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9840 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9841 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9842
9843 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9844 using a backslash ('\').
9845
9846 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9847 only related to authentication.
9848
9849 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9850 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9851 unobvious parameters.
9852
9853 Example :
9854 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9855 backend public_www
9856 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9857 stats enable
9858 stats hide-version
9859 stats scope .
9860 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009861 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009862 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9863 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9864
9865 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9866 backend private_monitoring
9867 stats enable
9868 stats uri /admin?stats
9869 stats refresh 5s
9870
9871 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9872
9873
9874stats refresh <delay>
9875 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009877 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009878 Arguments :
9879 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9880 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9881 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9882 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9883 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9884 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9885
9886 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9887 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9888 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -05009889 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009890
9891 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9892 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9893 unobvious parameters.
9894
9895 Example :
9896 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9897 backend public_www
9898 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9899 stats enable
9900 stats hide-version
9901 stats scope .
9902 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009903 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009904 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9905 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9906
9907 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9908 backend private_monitoring
9909 stats enable
9910 stats uri /admin?stats
9911 stats refresh 5s
9912
9913 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9914
9915
9916stats scope { <name> | "." }
9917 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009919 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009920 Arguments :
9921 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9922 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9923 section in which the statement appears.
9924
9925 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9926 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9927 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9928 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9929 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9930 exists.
9931
9932 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9933 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9934 unobvious parameters.
9935
9936 Example :
9937 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9938 backend public_www
9939 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9940 stats enable
9941 stats hide-version
9942 stats scope .
9943 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009944 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009945 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9946 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9947
9948 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9949 backend private_monitoring
9950 stats enable
9951 stats uri /admin?stats
9952 stats refresh 5s
9953
9954 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9955
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009956
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009957stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009958 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009960 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009961
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009962 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009963 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9964
9965 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9966 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9967
9968 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9969 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009970 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009971
9972 Example :
9973 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9974 backend private_monitoring
9975 stats enable
9976 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9977 stats uri /admin?stats
9978 stats refresh 5s
9979
9980 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9981 global section.
9982
9983
9984stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009985 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9987 yes | yes | yes | yes
9988 Arguments : none
9989
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009990 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009991 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9992 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9993 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9994 - IP (socket, server)
9995 - cookie (backend, server)
9996
9997 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9998 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009999 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010000
10001 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10002
10003
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010004stats show-modules
10005 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10007 yes | yes | yes | yes
10008 Arguments : none
10009
10010 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10011 values as a tooltip.
10012
10013 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10014 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10015 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10016
10017 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10018
10019
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010020stats show-node [ <name> ]
10021 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010023 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010024 Arguments:
10025 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10026 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10027
10028 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10029 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010030 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010031
10032 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10033 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10034 unobvious parameters.
10035
10036 Example:
10037 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10038 backend private_monitoring
10039 stats enable
10040 stats show-node Europe-1
10041 stats uri /admin?stats
10042 stats refresh 5s
10043
10044 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10045 section.
10046
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010047
10048stats uri <prefix>
10049 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010051 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010052 Arguments :
10053 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10054 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10055 query string.
10056
10057 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10058 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10059 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10060 possible to reach it in the application.
10061
10062 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010063 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010064 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10065 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10066 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10067 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10068
10069 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10070 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10071 an address or a port to statistics only.
10072
10073 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10074 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10075 unobvious parameters.
10076
10077 Example :
10078 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10079 backend public_www
10080 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10081 stats enable
10082 stats hide-version
10083 stats scope .
10084 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010085 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010086 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10087 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10088
10089 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10090 backend private_monitoring
10091 stats enable
10092 stats uri /admin?stats
10093 stats refresh 5s
10094
10095 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10096
10097
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010098stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10099 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010101 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010102
10103 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010104 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010105 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010106 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010107 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10108
10109 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10110 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10111 the "stick-table" statement.
10112
10113 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10114 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10115 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10116 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10117 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10118
10119 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10120 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10121 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10122 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10123 transformation rules.
10124
10125 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10126 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10127 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10128 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10129 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10130 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10131 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10132
10133 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10134 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10135 ACL based conditions.
10136
10137 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10138 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10139 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10140 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10141
10142 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10143 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10144 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10145 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10146
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010147 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10148 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010149 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010150
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010151 Example :
10152 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10153 # last 30 minutes
10154 backend pop
10155 mode tcp
10156 balance roundrobin
10157 stick store-request src
10158 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10159 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10160 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10161
10162 backend smtp
10163 mode tcp
10164 balance roundrobin
10165 stick match src table pop
10166 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10167 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10168
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010169 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010170 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010171
10172
10173stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10174 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10176 no | no | yes | yes
10177
10178 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10179 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10180 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10181 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10182
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010183 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10184 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010185 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010186
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010187 Examples :
10188 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010189 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010190
10191 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10192 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10193 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10194
10195
10196 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10197 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10198 backend http
10199 mode http
10200 balance roundrobin
10201 stick on src table https
10202 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10203 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10204 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10205
10206 backend https
10207 mode tcp
10208 balance roundrobin
10209 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10210 stick on src
10211 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10212 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10213
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010214 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010215
10216
10217stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10218 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10220 no | no | yes | yes
10221
10222 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010223 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010224 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010225 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010226 server is selected.
10227
10228 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10229 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10230 the "stick-table" statement.
10231
10232 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10233 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10234 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10235 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10236 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10237 address.
10238
10239 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10240 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10241 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10242 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10243 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10244 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10245 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10246 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10247 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10248 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10249
10250 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10251 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10252 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10253 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10254 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10255 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10256 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10257
10258 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10259 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10260 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10261 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10262
10263 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10264 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10265 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10266 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10267 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10268 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010269 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10270 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10271 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10272 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10273 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10274 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010275
10276 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10277 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10278 the request.
10279
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010280 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10281 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010282 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010283
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010284 Example :
10285 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10286 # last 30 minutes
10287 backend pop
10288 mode tcp
10289 balance roundrobin
10290 stick store-request src
10291 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10292 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10293 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10294
10295 backend smtp
10296 mode tcp
10297 balance roundrobin
10298 stick match src table pop
10299 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10300 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10301
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010302 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010303 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010304
10305
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010306stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010307 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10308 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010309 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010311 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010312
10313 Arguments :
10314 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10315 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10316 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10317 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10318
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010319 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10320 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10321 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10322 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10323
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010324 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10325 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10326 instance.
10327
10328 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10329 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10330 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10331 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10332 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10333 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010334 to 32 characters.
10335
10336 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10337 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10338 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010339 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010340 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10341 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010342
10343 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010344 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10345 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010346 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10347 increase.
10348
10349 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010350 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10351 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10352 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010353
10354 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10355 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10356 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10357 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010358 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010359 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10360 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10361 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10362 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10363 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10364 parameter (see below).
10365
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010366 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10367 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10368 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10369 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10370 soft restart.
10371
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010372 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10373 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010374
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010375 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10376 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10377 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10378 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010379 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010380 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010381 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10382 if not expiration delay is specified.
10383
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010384 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10385 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10386 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10387 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010388 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10389 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10390 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10391 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10392 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10393 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10394 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10395 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10396 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10397 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10398 types and their arguments.
10399
10400 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10401 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10402 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10403 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10404
10405 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10406 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10407 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010408 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010409
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010410 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10411 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10412 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010413 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010414 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010415 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010416
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010417 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10418 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10419 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10420 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10421
10422 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10423 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10424 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10425 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10426 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10427 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10428
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010429 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10430 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10431 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10432 they were received.
10433
10434 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10435 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10436 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10437 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10438 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10439
10440 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10441 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10442 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10443 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10444 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10445
10446 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10447 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10448 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10449
10450 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10451 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10452 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10453 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10454 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10455
10456 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10457 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10458 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10459 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10460 the client side.
10461
10462 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10463 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10464 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10465 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10466 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10467 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10468 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10469
10470 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10471 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10472 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10473 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10474 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10475 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010476 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010477
10478 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10479 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10480 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10481 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10482 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10483 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10484
10485 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010486 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010487 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10488 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10489
10490 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10491 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10492 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10493 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10494 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10495 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10496 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10497 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10498 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10499 recommended for better fairness.
10500
10501 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010502 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010503 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10504 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10505
10506 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10507 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10508 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10509 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10510 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10511 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10512 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10513 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10514 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10515 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010516
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010517 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10518 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010519 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10520 reference it.
10521
10522 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10523 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010524 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10525 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10526 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010527
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010528 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10529 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10530 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10531 something that can be ignored.
10532
10533 Example:
10534 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10535 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10536 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10537 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10538
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010539 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010540 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010541
10542
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010543stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010544 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10546 no | no | yes | yes
10547
10548 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010549 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010550 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010551 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010552 server is selected.
10553
10554 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10555 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10556 the "stick-table" statement.
10557
10558 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10559 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10560 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10561 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10562
10563 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10564 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10565 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10566 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10567 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10568 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010569 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010570 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10571 rules.
10572
10573 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10574 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10575 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10576 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10577 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10578 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10579 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10580
10581 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10582 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10583 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10584 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10585
10586 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10587 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10588 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10589 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10590 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10591 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010592 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10593 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10594 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10595 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10596 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10597 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10598 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10599 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10600 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010601
10602 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10603
10604 Example :
10605 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10606 backend https
10607 mode tcp
10608 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010609 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010610 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010611
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010612 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10613 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10614
10615 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10616 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10617 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10618
10619 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10620 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010621
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010622 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10623 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10624 # at offset 44.
10625
10626 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10627 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10628
10629 # Learn on response if server hello.
10630 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010631
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010632 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10633 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10634
10635 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10636 extraction.
10637
10638
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010639tcp-check comment <string>
10640 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10641 it fails.
10642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10643 yes | no | yes | yes
10644
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010645 Arguments :
10646 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10647 rule fails.
10648
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010649 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10650 user-friendly error reporting.
10651
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010652 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10653 "tcp-check expect".
10654
10655
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010656tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10657 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010658 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010659 Opens a new connection
10660 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010661 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010662
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010663 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010664 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10665
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010666 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010667 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010668
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010669 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010670 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10671 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010672 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010673
10674 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010675
10676 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10677
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010678 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10679
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010680 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10681
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010682 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10683
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010684 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10685 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10686 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10687 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10688
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010689 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10690 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10691 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10692 haproxy -vv.
10693
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010694 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010695
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010696 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10697 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10698 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10699
10700 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10701 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10702 of the sequence.
10703
10704 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10705 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10706 do.
10707
10708 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10709 unset-var or comment rules.
10710
10711 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010712 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10713 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10714 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10715 option tcp-check
10716 tcp-check connect
10717 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10718 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10719 tcp-check send \r\n
10720 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10721 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10722 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10723 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10724 tcp-check send \r\n
10725 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10726 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10727
10728 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10729 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010730 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010731 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10732 tcp-check connect port 143
10733 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10734 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10735
10736 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10737
10738
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010739tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010740 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010741 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010742 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010743 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010745 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010746
10747 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010748 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10749
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010750 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10751 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10752 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10753 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10754 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10755 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10756 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10757 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10758 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10759 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10760
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010761 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010762 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10763 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010764 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10765 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10766 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10767
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010768 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10769 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10770 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010771 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10772 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10773 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10774 example 404 with disable-on-404
10775 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10776 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010777 By default "L7OK" is used.
10778
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010779 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10780 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010781 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10782 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10783 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10784 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10785 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10786 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010787
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010788 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010789 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010790 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10791 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10792 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10793 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010794 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10795
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010796 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10797 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10798 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10799 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10800
10801 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10802 informational message reported in logs if an error
10803 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10804 log-format string.
10805
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010806 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10807 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10808 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10809 followed by some converters.
10810
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010811 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10812 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10813 with the usual backslash ('\').
10814 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010815 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010816 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10817 used upper or lower case.
10818
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010819 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10820
10821 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10822 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10823 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10824 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10825 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10826 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10827 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10828 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10829
10830 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10831 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10832 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10833 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10834 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10835 expression.
10836
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010837 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10838 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10839 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10840 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10841 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10842 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10843
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010844 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10845 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10846 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10847 this exact hexadecimal string.
10848 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10849
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010850 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10851 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10852 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10853 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10854 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10855 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10856 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10857 size.
10858
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010859 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10860 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10861 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10862 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10863 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10864 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10865 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10866 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10867 in a binary string before matching the response's
10868 buffer.
10869
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010870 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10871 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10872 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10873 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10874 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10875 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10876 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10877 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10878 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10879 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10880 the null character.
10881
10882 Examples :
10883 # perform a POP check
10884 option tcp-check
10885 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10886
10887 # perform an IMAP check
10888 option tcp-check
10889 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10890
10891 # look for the redis master server
10892 option tcp-check
10893 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010894 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010895 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10896 tcp-check expect string role:master
10897 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10898 tcp-check expect string +OK
10899
10900
10901 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10902 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10903
10904
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010905tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10906tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10907 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10908 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010909 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010910 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010911
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010912 Arguments :
10913 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10914
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010915 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10916 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010917
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010918 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10919 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010920
10921 Examples :
10922 # look for the redis master server
10923 option tcp-check
10924 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10925 tcp-check expect string role:master
10926
10927 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10928 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10929
10930
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010931tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10932tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10933 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10934 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010935 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010936 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010937
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010938 Arguments :
10939 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010940
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010941 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10942 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010943
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010944 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10945 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10946 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010947
10948 Examples :
10949 # redis check in binary
10950 option tcp-check
10951 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10952 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10953
10954
10955 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10956 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10957
10958
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010959tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010960 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010961 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010962 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010963
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010964 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010965 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10966 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10967 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10968 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10969 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10970 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10971 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10972 and '-'.
10973
10974 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10975
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010976 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010977 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10978
10979
10980tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010981 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010982 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010983 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010984
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010985 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010986 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10987 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10988 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10989 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10990 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10991 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10992 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10993 and '-'.
10994
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010995 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010996 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10997
10998
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010999tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11000 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11002 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011003 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011004 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11005 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011006
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011007 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011008
11009 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11010 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011011 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11012 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11013 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11014 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11015 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11016 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011018 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11019 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11020 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11021 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011022
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011023 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011024 - accept :
11025 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11026 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11027 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011028
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011029 - reject :
11030 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11031 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11032 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11033 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11034 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11035 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11036 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11037 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11038 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11039 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11040 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011041 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011042
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011043 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11044 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11045 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11046 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11047 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11048 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11049 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11050 hosts.
11051
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011052 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11053 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11054 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11055 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11056 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11057 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11058 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11059 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11060
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011061 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11062 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11063 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11064 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11065 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11066 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11067 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11068 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11069 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011070 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11071 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011072
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011073 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011074 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011075 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11076 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11077 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011078 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011079 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
11080 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11081 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11082 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11083 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11084 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11085 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11086 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011087
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011088 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011089 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011090 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011091 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011092 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11093 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11094 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011095
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011096 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11097 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11098 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11099 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011100
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011101 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11102 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11103 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11104 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11105 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011106 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11107 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11108 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11109 layer7 information is extracted.
11110
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011111 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11112 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11113 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11114 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11115 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011116
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011117 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11118 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11119 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11120 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11121
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011122 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11123 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11124 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11125 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11126
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011127 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11128 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11129 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11130 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11131 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011132
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011133 - set-src <expr> :
11134 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11135 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11136 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011137 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011138
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011139 Arguments:
11140 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11141 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011142
11143 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011144 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11145
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011146 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11147 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011148
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011149 - set-src-port <expr> :
11150 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11151 expression.
11152
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011153 Arguments:
11154 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11155 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011156
11157 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011158 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11159
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011160 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11161 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11162 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011163
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011164 - set-dst <expr> :
11165 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11166 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11167 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11168 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11169 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11170
11171 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11172 followed by some converters.
11173
11174 Example:
11175
11176 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11177 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11178
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011179 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11180 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11181
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011182 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11183 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11184 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11185 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11186
11187
11188 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11189 followed by some converters.
11190
11191 Example:
11192
11193 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11194
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011195 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11196 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11197 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11198
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011199 - "silent-drop" :
11200 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011201 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011202 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11203 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11204 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11205 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11206 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011207 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11208 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011209 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11210 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011211 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011212 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11213 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11214 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11215 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11216
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011217 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11218 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11219 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011220
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011221 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11222 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11223 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011224
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011225 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011226 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011227 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011228
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011229 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11230 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11231 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011232
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011233 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011234 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11235 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011236
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011237 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11238
11239 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11240
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011241 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11242
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011243 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011244
11245
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011246tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11247 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011249 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011250 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011251 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11252 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011253
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011254 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011255
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011256 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011257 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11258 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11259 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11260 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011261
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011262 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11263 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11264 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11265 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011266 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11267 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11268 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11269 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11270 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11271 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011272 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011273 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011275 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11276 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11277 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11278 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011279
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011280 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011281 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011282 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011283 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11284 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011285 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011286 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011287 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011288 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011289 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011290 - set-dst <expr>
11291 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011292 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011293 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011294 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011295 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011296 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011297
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011298 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11299 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011300 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11301 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011302
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011303 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11304 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11305 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11306 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11307 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11308 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011309
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011310 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011311 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11312 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011313
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011314 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11315 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11316 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11317 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11318 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11319 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11320
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011321 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011322 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11323 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11324 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11325 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11326 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11327 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11328 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11329 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11330 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11331 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011332
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011333 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011334 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11335 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11336 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011337
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011338 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11339 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11340
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011341 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011342 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11343 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011344
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011345 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11346 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011347 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011348 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11349 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011350 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011351 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011352 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011353 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11354 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011355 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011356 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11357 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011358
11359 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11360 followed by some converters.
11361
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011362 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11363 <var-name>.
11364
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011365 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11366 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11367 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11368 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11369 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11370
11371 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11372 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11373 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11374 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11375 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11376 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11377 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11378 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11379 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11380 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11381 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11382
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011383 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11384 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11385 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11386 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11387 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11388
11389 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11390
11391 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11392
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011393 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11394 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11395 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11396 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11397 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11398 evaluated.
11399
11400 Example:
11401 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11402
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011403 Example:
11404
11405 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011406 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011407
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011408 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011409 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11410 # and reject everything else.
11411 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11412 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011413 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011414 tcp-request content reject
11415
11416 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011417 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11418 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11419 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011420 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011421
11422 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11423 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11424 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011425 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011426 tcp-request content reject
11427
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011428 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011429 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011430 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011431 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011432 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11433 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011434
11435 Example:
11436 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11437 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011438 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011439
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011440 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011441 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011442
11443 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011444 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011445 # protecting all our sites
11446 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011447 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11448 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011449 ...
11450 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11451
11452 backend http_dynamic
11453 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011454 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011455 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011456 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011457 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011458 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011459 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011461 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011462
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011463 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11464 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011465
11466
11467tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11468 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011470 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011471 Arguments :
11472 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11473 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11474 as explained at the top of this document.
11475
11476 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11477 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11478 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11479 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11480 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11481
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011482 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11483 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11484 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11485 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11486
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011487 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11488 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011489 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011490 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011491 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11492 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11493 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11494 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011495
11496 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11497 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11498 it pass through unaffected.
11499
11500 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11501 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11502 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011503 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011504 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11505 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011506 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11507 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11508 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011509
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011510 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011511 "timeout client".
11512
11513
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011514tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11515 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11517 no | no | yes | yes
11518 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011519 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11520 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011521
11522 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11523
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011524 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011525 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11526 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011527 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11528 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011529
11530 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11531
11532 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11533 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11534 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11535 inserted.
11536
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011537 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011538 - accept :
11539 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11540 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11541 the rules evaluation.
11542
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011543 - close :
11544 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11545 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11546 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11547 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11548 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11549 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011550 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011551 protocols.
11552
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011553 - reject :
11554 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11555 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011556 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011557
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011558 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11559 Sets a variable.
11560
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011561 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11562 Unsets a variable.
11563
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011564 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11565 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11566 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11567 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11568
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011569 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11570 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11571 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11572 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11573
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011574 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11575 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11576 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11577 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11578 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011579
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011580 - "silent-drop" :
11581 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011582 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011583 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11584 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11585 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11586 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11587 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011588 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11589 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011590 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11591 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011592 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011593 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11594 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11595 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11596 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11597
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011598 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11599 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11600
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011601 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11602 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11603 for changing the default action to a reject.
11604
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011605 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11606 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11607 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11608 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011609 period.
11610
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011611 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11612 declared inline.
11613
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011614 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11615 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011616 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011617 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11618 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011619 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011620 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011621 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011622 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11623 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011624 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011625 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11626 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011627
11628 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11629 followed by some converters.
11630
11631 Example:
11632
11633 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11634
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011635 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11636 <var-name>.
11637
11638 Example:
11639
11640 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11641
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011642 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11643 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11644 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11645 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11646 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11647
11648 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11649
11650 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11651
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011652 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11653
11654 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11655
11656
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011657tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11658 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11660 no | yes | yes | no
11661 Arguments :
11662 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11663 below.
11664
11665 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11666
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011667 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011668 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11669 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11670 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11671 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11672 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11673 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11674 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011675 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011676 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11677 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11678 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11679 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11680 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11681 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11682 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11683 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11684 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11685 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11686 instead.
11687
11688 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11689 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11690 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11691 rules which may be inserted.
11692
11693 Several types of actions are supported :
11694 - accept : the request is accepted
11695 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11696 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11697 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011698 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011699 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011700 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011701 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011702 - silent-drop
11703
11704 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11705 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11706 sections for a complete description.
11707
11708 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11709 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11710 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11711
11712 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11713 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11714 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11715 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11716 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11717
11718 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11719 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11720
11721 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11722 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11723 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11724
11725 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11726 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11727 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11728
11729 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11730 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11731 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11732
11733 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11734 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11735 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11736
11737 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11738
11739 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11740
11741
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011742tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11743 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11745 no | no | yes | yes
11746 Arguments :
11747 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11748 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11749 as explained at the top of this document.
11750
11751 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11752
11753
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011754timeout check <timeout>
11755 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11756 established.
11757
11758 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11759 yes | no | yes | yes
11760 Arguments:
11761 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11762 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11763 as explained at the top of this document.
11764
11765 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11766 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011767 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011768 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011769 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11770 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11771 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011772
11773 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11774 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11775
11776 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11777 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011778 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011779
11780 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11781 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11782 forget about it.
11783
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011784 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11785 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011786
11787
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011788timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011789 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11791 yes | yes | yes | no
11792 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011793 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011794 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11795 as explained at the top of this document.
11796
11797 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11798 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11799 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011800 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11801 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11802 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11803 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011804 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11805 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11806 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011807 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011808 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011809 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11810 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011811 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11812 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011813
11814 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11815 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11816 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11817 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011818 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011819 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11820
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011821 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011822
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011823 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011824
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011825
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011826timeout client-fin <timeout>
11827 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11829 yes | yes | yes | no
11830 Arguments :
11831 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11832 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11833 as explained at the top of this document.
11834
11835 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11836 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11837 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11838 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11839 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11840 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11841 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011842 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11843 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11844 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011845
11846 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11847 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11848 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11849
11850 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11851
11852
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011853timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011854 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11856 yes | no | yes | yes
11857 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011858 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011859 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11860 as explained at the top of this document.
11861
11862 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011863 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011864 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011865 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011866 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11867 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011868
11869 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11870 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11871 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11872 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011873 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011874 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11875
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011876 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011878
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011879timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11880 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11882 yes | yes | yes | yes
11883 Arguments :
11884 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11885 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11886 as explained at the top of this document.
11887
11888 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11889 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11890 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11891 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11892 once the request has started to present itself.
11893
11894 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11895 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11896 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11897 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11898 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11899
11900 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11901 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11902 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11903 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11904
11905 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11906 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011907 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011908 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11909 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011910 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011911
11912 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11913 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11914 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11915 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11916
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011917 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11918 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011919 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11920
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011921 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11922
11923
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011924timeout http-request <timeout>
11925 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011927 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011928 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011929 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011930 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11931 as explained at the top of this document.
11932
11933 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11934 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11935 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11936 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11937 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11938 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11939 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011940 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11941 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11942 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11943 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011944 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011945 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11946 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011947
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011948 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11949 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11950 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11951 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11952 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011953 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011954
11955 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11956 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011957 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011958 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11959 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11960
11961 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011962 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11963 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11964 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011965
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011966 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011967 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011968
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011969
11970timeout queue <timeout>
11971 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11973 yes | no | yes | yes
11974 Arguments :
11975 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11976 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11977 as explained at the top of this document.
11978
11979 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11980 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11981 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11982 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11983 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11984
11985 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11986 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11987 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11988 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11989
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011990 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011991
11992
11993timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011994 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11996 yes | no | yes | yes
11997 Arguments :
11998 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11999 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12000 as explained at the top of this document.
12001
12002 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12003 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12004 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12005 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12006 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12007 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12008 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12009
12010 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12011 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12012 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12013 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12014 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012015 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012016 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012017 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12018 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012019 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12020 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012021
12022 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12023 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12024 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12025 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012026 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012027 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12028
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012029 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012030
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012031
12032timeout server-fin <timeout>
12033 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12035 yes | no | yes | yes
12036 Arguments :
12037 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12038 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12039 as explained at the top of this document.
12040
12041 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12042 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12043 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12044 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12045 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12046 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12047 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12048 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12049 situations, it should not be needed.
12050
12051 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12052 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12053 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12054
12055 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12056
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012057
12058timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012059 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12061 yes | yes | yes | yes
12062 Arguments :
12063 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12064 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12065 as explained at the top of this document.
12066
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012067 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12068 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12069 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012070
12071 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12072 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12073 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12074 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012075 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012076
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012077 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012078
12079
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012080timeout tunnel <timeout>
12081 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12083 yes | no | yes | yes
12084 Arguments :
12085 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12086 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12087 as explained at the top of this document.
12088
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012089 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012090 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12091 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12092 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012093 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12094 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012095 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12096 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12097 specified.
12098
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012099 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12100 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12101 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12102 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12103 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12104 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12105 state.
12106
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012107 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12108 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12109 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12110 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012111 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012112
12113 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12114 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12115 forget about it.
12116
12117 Example :
12118 defaults http
12119 option http-server-close
12120 timeout connect 5s
12121 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012122 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012123 timeout server 30s
12124 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12125
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012126 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012127
12128
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012129transparent (deprecated)
12130 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012132 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012133 Arguments : none
12134
12135 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12136 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12137 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12138 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12139 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12140 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12141 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12142 appropriate server.
12143
12144 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12145
12146 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12147 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12148
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012149 See also: "option transparent"
12150
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012151unique-id-format <string>
12152 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12154 yes | yes | yes | no
12155 Arguments :
12156 <string> is a log-format string.
12157
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012158 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12159 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12160 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12161 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012162
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012163 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12164 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12165 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12166 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12167 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12168 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12169 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12170 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012171
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012172 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12173 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012174
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012175 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012176
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012177 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012178
12179 will generate:
12180
12181 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12182
12183 See also: "unique-id-header"
12184
12185unique-id-header <name>
12186 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12188 yes | yes | yes | no
12189 Arguments :
12190 <name> is the name of the header.
12191
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012192 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12193 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012194
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012195 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012196
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012197 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012198 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12199
12200 will generate:
12201
12202 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12203
12204 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012205
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012206use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012207 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12209 no | yes | yes | no
12210 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012211 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12212 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012213
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012214 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12215 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012216
12217 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12218 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12219 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012220 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012221 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012222 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12223 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012224
12225 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12226 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12227 assign the backend.
12228
12229 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12230 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12231 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12232 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12233 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12234 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12235
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012236 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012237 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012238 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12239 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12240 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12241
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012242 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12243 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12244 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12245 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12246 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12247 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12248 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12249 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12250 cannot be forced from the request.
12251
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012252 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012253 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12254 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12255
12256 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12257 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012258
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012259use-fcgi-app <name>
12260 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12262 no | no | yes | yes
12263 Arguments :
12264 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12265
12266 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012267
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012268use-server <server> if <condition>
12269use-server <server> unless <condition>
12270 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12272 no | no | yes | yes
12273 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012274 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12275 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012276
12277 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12278
12279 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12280 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12281 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12282
12283 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12284 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12285 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12286 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12287 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12288 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12289 matches will assign the server.
12290
12291 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12292 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12293 with the next rules until one matches.
12294
12295 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12296 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12297 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12298 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12299
12300 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12301 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12302 stripped.
12303
12304 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12305 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012306 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12307 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12308 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012309
12310 Example :
12311 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12312 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12313 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12314 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012315 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012316 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012317 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012318 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12319 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12320
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012321 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12322 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12323 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12324 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012325 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012326 and we fall back to load balancing.
12327
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012328 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012329
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012330
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100123315. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012332--------------------------
12333
12334The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12335depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12336settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12337written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12338described in this section.
12339
12340
123415.1. Bind options
12342-----------------
12343
12344The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12345as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12346no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12347parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12348while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12349provided immediately after the setting name.
12350
12351The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12352
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012353accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12354 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12355 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12356 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12357 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12358 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12359 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12360 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12361 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12362 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012363 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12364 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12365 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012366
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012367accept-proxy
12368 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012369 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12370 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012371 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12372 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12373 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12374 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012375 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012376 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12377 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012378 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12379 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012380
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012381allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012382 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012383 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012384 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012385 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12386 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012387
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012388alpn <protocols>
12389 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12390 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12391 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012392 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012393 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012394 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12395 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12396 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12397 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12398 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12399 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12400 preference, like below :
12401
12402 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012403
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012404backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012405 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012406 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12407
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012408curves <curves>
12409 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12410 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12411 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12412 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12413 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12414 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12415
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012416ecdhe <named curve>
12417 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012418 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12419 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012420
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012421ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012422 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12423 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12424 client's certificate.
12425
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012426ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12427 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12428 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12429 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12430 error is ignored.
12431
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012432ca-sign-file <cafile>
12433 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12434 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12435 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12436 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12437 'generate-certificates' for details.
12438
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012439ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012440 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12441 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12442 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12443 'generate-certificates' for details.
12444
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012445ca-verify-file <cafile>
12446 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12447 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12448 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12449 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12450 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12451
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012452ciphers <ciphers>
12453 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12454 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012455 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012456 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012457 information and recommendations see e.g.
12458 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12459 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12460 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12461
12462ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12463 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12464 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12465 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12466 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012467 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12468 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012469
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012470crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012471 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12472 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12473 to verify client's certificate.
12474
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012475crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012476 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12477 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12478 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12479 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12480 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012481 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12482 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012483
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012484 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12485 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12486
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012487 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12488 are loaded.
12489
12490 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012491 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12492 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12493 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12494 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12495 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12496 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12497 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012498 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012499
12500 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12501 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12502 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12503 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012504 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12505 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012506
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012507 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012508
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012509 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012510 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012511 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12512 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012513 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12514 clients).
12515
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012516 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12517 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12518 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12519 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12520 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12521 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12522 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12523 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12524 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12525 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12526 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12527 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12528 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12529
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012530 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12531 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12532 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12533 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12534 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12535
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012536 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12537 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12538 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12539 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012540
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012541 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12542 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12543 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012544
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012545crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012546 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012547 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012548 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012549 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012550
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012551crt-list <file>
12552 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012553 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12554 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012555
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012556 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12557
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012558 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12559 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12560 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12561 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12562 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012563
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012564 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12565 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12566 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12567 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12568 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12569 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12570 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12571 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012572
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012573 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12574 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12575 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012576
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012577 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12578
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012579 crt-list file example:
12580 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012581 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012582 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012583 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012584 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012585
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012586defer-accept
12587 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12588 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12589 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012590 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012591 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12592 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12593 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12594 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12595 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12596 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12597 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12598
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012599expose-fd listeners
12600 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12601 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012602 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12603 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012604 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012605
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012606force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012607 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012608 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012609 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012610 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012611
12612force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012613 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012614 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012615 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012616
12617force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012618 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012619 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012620 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012621
12622force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012623 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012624 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012625 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012626
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012627force-tlsv13
12628 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12629 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012630 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012631
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012632generate-certificates
12633 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12634 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12635 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12636 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12637 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12638 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12639 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12640 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12641 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12642 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12643 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12644
12645 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12646 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012647 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012648 certificate is used many times.
12649
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012650gid <gid>
12651 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12652 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12653 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12654 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12655 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12656
12657group <group>
12658 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12659 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12660 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12661 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12662 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12663
12664id <id>
12665 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12666 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12667 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12668 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12669
12670interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012671 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12672 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12673 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12674 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12675 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12676 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012677 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12678 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12679 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12680 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12681 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12682 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012683
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012684level <level>
12685 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12686 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12687 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012688 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012689 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12690 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12691 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012692 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012693 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012694 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012695 all counters).
12696
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012697severity-output <format>
12698 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12699 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12700 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12701 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12702 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12703 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12704 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12705 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12706 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12707 rfc5424 convention.
12708
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012709maxconn <maxconn>
12710 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12711 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12712 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12713 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12714 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12715 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12716 eat all memory.
12717
12718mode <mode>
12719 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12720 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12721 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12722 UNIX sockets.
12723
12724mss <maxseg>
12725 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12726 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12727 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12728 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12729 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12730 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12731 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12732 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12733 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12734 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12735 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12736
12737name <name>
12738 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12739 page.
12740
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012741namespace <name>
12742 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12743 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12744 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12745 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12746
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012747nice <nice>
12748 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12749 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12750 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12751 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12752 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12753 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12754 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12755 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12756 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12757 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12758 one for an RDP socket.
12759
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012760no-ca-names
12761 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12762 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012763 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012764
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012765no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012766 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012767 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012768 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012769 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012770 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12771 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012772
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012773no-tls-tickets
12774 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12775 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12776 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012777 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12778 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012779 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12780 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12781 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012782
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012783no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012784 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012785 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012786 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012787 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012788 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12789 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012790
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012791no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012792 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012793 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012794 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012795 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012796 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12797 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012798
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012799no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012801 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012802 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012803 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012804 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12805 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012806
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012807no-tlsv13
12808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12809 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12810 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12811 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012812 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12813 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012814
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012815npn <protocols>
12816 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12817 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12818 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012819 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012820 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012821 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12822 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12823 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12824 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12825 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012826
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012827prefer-client-ciphers
12828 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12829 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12830 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012831 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12832 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12833 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012834
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012835process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012836 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012837 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012838 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012839 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12840 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12841 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12842 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012843 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012844 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12845 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12846 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12847 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12848 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012849
12850 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12851
12852 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12853 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12854 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12855 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12856 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12857 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12858 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12859 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012860
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012861proto <name>
12862 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12863 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12864 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12865 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012866 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012867 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012868 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012869 h2" on the bind line.
12870
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012871ssl
12872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012873 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012874 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12875 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012876 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12877 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012878
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012879ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12880 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012881 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12882 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12883 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012884 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12885
12886ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012887 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12888 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12889 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12890 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012891
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012892strict-sni
12893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12894 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12895 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12896 See the "crt" option for more information.
12897
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012898tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012899 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012900 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12901 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012902 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012903 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12904 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12905 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12906 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12907 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12908 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12909 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12910
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012911tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012912 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012913 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12914 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12915 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12916 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12917 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12918 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12919 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012920 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12921 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12922 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012923
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012924tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12925 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012926 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12927 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12928 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12929 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12930 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12931 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12932 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12933 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12934 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12935 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012936 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12937 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12938
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012939transparent
12940 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12941 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12942 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12943 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12944 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12945 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12946 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12947 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12948 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12949 so check for support with your vendor.
12950
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012951v4v6
12952 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12953 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12954 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12955 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012956 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012957
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012958v6only
12959 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12960 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12961 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012962 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12963 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012964
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012965uid <uid>
12966 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12967 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12968 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12969 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12970 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12971
12972user <user>
12973 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12974 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12975 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12976 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12977 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12978
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012979verify [none|optional|required]
12980 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12981 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12982 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12983 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12984 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012985 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12986 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12987 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12988 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012989
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200129905.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012991------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012993The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12994which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12995arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12996settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12997after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12998Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12999address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013001 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013002 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013003
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013004Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13005keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13006
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013007The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013008
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013009addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013010 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013011 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13012 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13013 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13014 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13015 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013016
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013017agent-check
13018 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013019 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013020 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13021 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13022 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013023
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013024 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013025 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013026 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13027 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13028 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013029
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013030 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13031 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13032 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13033 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13034 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013035
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013036 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013037 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013038
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013039 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13040 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13041 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013042
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013043 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13044 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13045 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013046
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013047 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013048 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13049 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13050 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13051 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013052 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013053 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013054
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013055 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13056 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013057
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013058 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13059 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13060 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13061 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13062 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13063 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13064 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13065 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13066 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013067
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013068 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13069 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013070 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13071 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13072 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013073 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013074
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013075 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013076 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013077
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013078agent-send <string>
13079 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13080 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13081 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13082 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13083 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13084
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013085agent-inter <delay>
13086 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13087 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13088
13089 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13090 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13091 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13092 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13093 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13094 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13095 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13096 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13097 of backends use the same servers.
13098
13099 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13100
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013101agent-addr <addr>
13102 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13103
13104 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13105 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13106 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13107 hostname, it will be resolved.
13108
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013109agent-port <port>
13110 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13111
13112 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13113
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013114allow-0rtt
13115 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013116 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13117 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013118
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013119alpn <protocols>
13120 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13121 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13122 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013123 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013124 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13125 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13126 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13127 now obsolete NPN extension.
13128 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13129 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13130
13131 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13132
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013133backup
13134 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13135 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13136 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13137 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013138 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13139 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013140
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013141ca-file <cafile>
13142 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13143 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13144 server's certificate.
13145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013146check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013147 This option enables health checks on a server:
13148 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13149 considered available.
13150 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13151 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13152 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13153 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13154 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13155 set.
13156 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13157 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13158 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13159 exchanges succeed.
13160
13161 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13162 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13163 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13164 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13165 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013166 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013167 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13168
13169 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13170 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13171
13172 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13173 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13174
13175 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13176 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13177 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13178 available.
13179
13180 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13181 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13182 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13183
13184 Example:
13185 # simple tcp check
13186 backend foo
13187 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13188 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13189 backend foo
13190 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13191 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13192 backend foo
13193 option tcp-check
13194 tcp-check connect
13195 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013196
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013197check-send-proxy
13198 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13199 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13200 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13201 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13202 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13203 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13204 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13205
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013206check-alpn <protocols>
13207 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13208 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13209 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13210
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013211check-proto <name>
13212 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13213 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13214 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13215 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013216 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013217 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13218 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13219
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013220check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013221 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013222 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13223 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013224
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013225check-ssl
13226 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13227 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13228 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13229 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013230 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013231 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13232 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013233 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013234 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13235 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013236
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013237check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013238 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013239 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13240 for normal traffic.
13241
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013242ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013243 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13244 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13245 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013246 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13247 information and recommendations see e.g.
13248 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13249 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13250 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013251
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013252ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13253 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13254 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13255 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13256 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013257 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13258 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13259 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013261cookie <value>
13262 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13263 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13264 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13265 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13266 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13267 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13268 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13269
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013270crl-file <crlfile>
13271 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13272 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13273 to verify server's certificate.
13274
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013275crt <cert>
13276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13277 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13278 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13279 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13280 certificate request.
13281
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013282disabled
13283 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13284 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13285 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13286 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13287 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013288 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013289
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013290enabled
13291 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13292 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13293 default value.
13294 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13295 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013296
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013297error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013298 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13299 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13300 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013302 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013303
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013304fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013305 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13306 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13307 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13308
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013309force-sslv3
13310 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13311 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013312 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013313 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013314
13315force-tlsv10
13316 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013317 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013318 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013319
13320force-tlsv11
13321 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013322 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013323 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013324
13325force-tlsv12
13326 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013327 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013328 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013329
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013330force-tlsv13
13331 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13332 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013333 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013335id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013336 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13337 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13338 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013339
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013340init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13341 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13342 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013343 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013344 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13345 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13346 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13347 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13348 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13349 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13350 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13351 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13352 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013353 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013354 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13355 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13356 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13357 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13358 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13359 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013360 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013361
13362 Example:
13363 defaults
13364 # never fail on address resolution
13365 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013367inter <delay>
13368fastinter <delay>
13369downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013370 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13371 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13372 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13373 between checks depending on the server state :
13374
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013375 Server state | Interval used
13376 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13377 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13378 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13379 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13380 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13381 or yet unchecked. |
13382 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13383 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13384 | "inter" otherwise.
13385 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013386
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013387 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13388 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13389 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13390 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013391 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13392 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13393 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13394 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13395 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013396
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013397log-proto <logproto>
13398 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13399 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13400 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13401 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13402
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013403maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013404 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13405 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013406 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13407 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013408 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13409 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13410 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13411 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13412
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013413 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13414 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13415 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13416 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13417 than 50 concurrent requests.
13418
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013419maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013420 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13421 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13422 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13423 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13424 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13425 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13426 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13427
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013428max-reuse <count>
13429 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13430 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13431 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13432 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13433 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13434 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13435 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13436 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013438minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013439 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13440 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13441 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13442 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13443 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13444 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013445 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013446 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013447
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013448namespace <name>
13449 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13450 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13451 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13452 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13453
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013454no-agent-check
13455 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13456 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13457 default value.
13458 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13459 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13460
13461no-backup
13462 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13463 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13464 default value.
13465 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13466 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13467
13468no-check
13469 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13470 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13471 default value.
13472 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13473 "default-server" "check" setting.
13474
13475no-check-ssl
13476 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13477 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13478 default value.
13479 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13480 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13481
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013482no-send-proxy
13483 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13484 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13485 default value.
13486 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13487 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13488
13489no-send-proxy-v2
13490 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13491 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13492 default value.
13493 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13494 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13495
13496no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13497 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13498 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13499 default value.
13500 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13501 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13502
13503no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13504 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13505 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13506 default value.
13507 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13508 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13509
13510no-ssl
13511 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13512 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13513 default value.
13514 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13515 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13516
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013517no-ssl-reuse
13518 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13519 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13520 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13521 and for paranoid users.
13522
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013523no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013524 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13525 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013526 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013527
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013528 Supported in default-server: No
13529
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013530no-tls-tickets
13531 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13532 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13533 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013534 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13535 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013536 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13537 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13538 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013539 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013540
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013541no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013542 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013543 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13544 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013545 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13546 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013547 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013548
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013549 Supported in default-server: No
13550
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013551no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013552 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013553 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13554 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013555 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13556 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013557 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013558
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013559 Supported in default-server: No
13560
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013561no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013562 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013563 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13564 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013565 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13566 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013567 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013568
13569 Supported in default-server: No
13570
13571no-tlsv13
13572 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13573 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13574 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13575 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13576 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013577 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013578
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013579 Supported in default-server: No
13580
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013581no-verifyhost
13582 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13583 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13584 default value.
13585 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13586 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013587
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013588no-tfo
13589 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13590 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13591 default value.
13592 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13593 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13594
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013595non-stick
13596 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13597 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13598 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13599
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013600npn <protocols>
13601 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13602 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13603 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013604 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013605 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13606 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13607 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13608
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013609observe <mode>
13610 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13611 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13612 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13613 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13614 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13615 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013616 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013617
13618 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13619
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013620on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013621 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13622 Currently, four modes are available:
13623 - fastinter: force fastinter
13624 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13625 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13626 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13627 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13628
13629 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13630
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013631on-marked-down <action>
13632 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13633 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013634 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13635 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13636 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13637 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13638 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13639 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13640 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13641 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013642
13643 Actions are disabled by default
13644
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013645on-marked-up <action>
13646 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13647 Currently one action is available:
13648 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13649 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13650 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13651 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013652 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13653 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013654 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13655 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13656
13657 Actions are disabled by default
13658
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013659pool-low-conn <max>
13660 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13661 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13662 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13663 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13664 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13665 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13666 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13667 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13668 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13669 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13670 applying to "http-reuse".
13671
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013672pool-max-conn <max>
13673 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13674 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13675 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13676 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13677 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13678 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13679
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013680pool-purge-delay <delay>
13681 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013682 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013683 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013684
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013685port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013686 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13687 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13688 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13689 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13690 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13691 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13692
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013693proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013694 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13695 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13696 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13697 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013698 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013699 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13700
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013701redir <prefix>
13702 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13703 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13704 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13705 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13706 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13707 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13708 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13709 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013710 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013711 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013712 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13713 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13714 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13715 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13716
13717 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013719rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013720 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13721 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13722 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13723
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013724resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13725 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13726 server.
13727
13728 Available options:
13729
13730 * allow-dup-ip
13731 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13732 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13733 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13734 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13735 For such case, simply enable this option.
13736 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13737
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013738 * ignore-weight
13739 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13740 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13741 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13742
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013743 * prevent-dup-ip
13744 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13745 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13746 same fqdn.
13747 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13748
13749 Example:
13750 backend b_myapp
13751 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13752 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13753 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13754
13755 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13756 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13757 it
13758 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13759 different address
13760
13761 Default value: not set
13762
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013763resolve-prefer <family>
13764 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13765 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13766 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13767 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13768
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013769 Default value: ipv6
13770
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013771 Example:
13772
13773 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013774
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013775resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013776 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013777 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013778 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013779 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13780 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013781 configured network, another address is selected.
13782
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013783 Example:
13784
13785 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013786
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013787resolvers <id>
13788 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13789 hostname.
13790
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013791 Example:
13792
13793 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013794
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013795 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013796
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013797send-proxy
13798 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13799 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13800 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13801 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013802 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13803 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13804 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13805 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13806 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13807 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13808 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13809 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13810 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13811 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013812 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13813 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013814
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013815send-proxy-v2
13816 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13817 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13818 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13819 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013820 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13821 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13822 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13823 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013824
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013825proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013826 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13827 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13828
13829 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13830 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13831 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13832 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13833 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13834 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13835 connection is supported).
13836 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13837 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13838 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13839 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13840 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13841 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13842 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013843
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013844send-proxy-v2-ssl
13845 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13846 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13847 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13848 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13849 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13850 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13851 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013852 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13853 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013854
13855send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13856 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13857 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13858 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13859 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13860 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13861 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13862 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13863 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013864 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13865 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013867slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013868 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13869 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13870 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13871 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13872 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13873 parameters :
13874
13875 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13876 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13877
13878 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13879 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13880 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13881 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13882
13883 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13884 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13885 seen as failed.
13886
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013887sni <expression>
13888 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13889 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13890 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13891 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013892 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13893 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013894 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013895 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13896 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013897
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013898source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013899source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013900source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013901 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13902 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13903 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13904 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13905
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013906 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13907 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13908 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13909 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13910 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13911 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13912 server.
13913
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013914 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13915 specifying the source address without port(s).
13916
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013917ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013918 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13919 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13920 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13921 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13922 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13923 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013924 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13925 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013926
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013927ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13928 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13929 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13930 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13931
13932ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13933 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13934 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13935 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13936
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013937ssl-reuse
13938 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13939 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13940 default value.
13941 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13942 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13943
13944stick
13945 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13946 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13947 default value.
13948 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13949 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013950
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013951socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013952 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013953 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13954 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13955
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013956tcp-ut <delay>
13957 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13958 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13959 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013960 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013961 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13962 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13963 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13964 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13965 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13966 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13967 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13968 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13969 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13970
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013971tfo
13972 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13973 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13974 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13975 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13976 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013977 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013979track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013980 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13981 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13982 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13983 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013984 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13985
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013986tls-tickets
13987 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13988 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13989 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013990 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13991 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13992 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013993 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013994 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013995
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013996verify [none|required]
13997 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013998 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013999 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14000 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014001 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014002 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14003 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14004 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14005 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14006 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14007 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14008 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14009 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014010
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014011verifyhost <hostname>
14012 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014013 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14014 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14015 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14016 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14017 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14018 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14019 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14020 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014022weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014023 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14024 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14025 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014026 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14027 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14028 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14029 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14030 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14031 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014032
14033
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140345.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14035-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014036
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014037HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14038using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14039configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014040This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14041can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14042workload.
14043This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14044resolution at run time.
14045Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14046carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14047
14048
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140495.3.1. Global overview
14050----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014051
14052As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14053different steps of the process life:
14054
14055 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14056 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14057 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14058
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014059 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14060 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014061
14062A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14063 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14064 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14065 resolution to know this new IP.
14066
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014067When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014068HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014069SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14070from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14071will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14072will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014073
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014074A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014075 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014076 first valid response.
14077
14078 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14079 servers return an error.
14080
14081
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140825.3.2. The resolvers section
14083----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014084
14085This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014086HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14087contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014088
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014089When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14090uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14091is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14092answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14093
14094When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014095used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014096
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014097 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14098 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14099 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014100
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014101 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14102 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014103
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014104 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14105 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14106 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014107
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014108For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14109following scenarios are possible:
14110
14111 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14112 ignored
14113
14114 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14115 applied
14116
14117 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14118 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14119
14120 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14121 retries the query with a new type
14122
14123 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14124 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014125
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014126As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14127a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014128<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014129
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014130
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014131resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014132 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014133
14134A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14135
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014136accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014137 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014138 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014139 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14140 by RFC 6891)
14141
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014142 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14143
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014144nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14145 DNS server description:
14146 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14147 <ip> : IP address of the server
14148 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14149
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014150parse-resolv-conf
14151 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14152 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14153 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14154
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014155hold <status> <period>
14156 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14157 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014158 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014159 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014160 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14161 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14162 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14163
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014164 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014165
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014166resolve_retries <nb>
14167 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14168 giving up.
14169 Default value: 3
14170
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014171 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14172 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14173 type.
14174
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014175timeout <event> <time>
14176 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14177 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14178 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014179 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14180 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014181 Default value: 1s
14182 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014183 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014184 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014185 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14186 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14187
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014188 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014189
14190 resolvers mydns
14191 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14192 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014193 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014194 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014195 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014196 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014197 hold other 30s
14198 hold refused 30s
14199 hold nx 30s
14200 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014201 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014202 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014203
14204
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200142056. Cache
14206---------
14207
14208HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14209(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14210RAM.
14211
14212The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14213this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14214
14215If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14216independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14217when we try to allocate a new one.
14218
14219The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14220
14221It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14222"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14223for more details.
14224
14225When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14226replaced by "<CACHE>".
14227
14228
142296.1. Limitation
14230----------------
14231
14232The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14233
14234- If the response is not a 200
14235- If the response contains a Vary header
14236- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14237- If the response is not cacheable
14238
14239- If the request is not a GET
14240- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14241- If the request contains an Authorization header
14242
14243
142446.2. Setup
14245-----------
14246
14247To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14248the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14249
14250
142516.2.1. Cache section
14252---------------------
14253
14254cache <name>
14255 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14256 size of cache is mandatory.
14257
14258total-max-size <megabytes>
14259 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14260 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14261
14262max-object-size <bytes>
14263 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14264 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14265 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14266
14267max-age <seconds>
14268 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14269 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14270 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14271 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14272 default.
14273
14274
142756.2.2. Proxy section
14276---------------------
14277
14278http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14279 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14280 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14281 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14282 after this one.
14283
14284http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14285 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14286 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14287 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14288 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14289
14290
14291Example:
14292
14293 backend bck1
14294 mode http
14295
14296 http-request cache-use foobar
14297 http-response cache-store foobar
14298 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14299
14300 cache foobar
14301 total-max-size 4
14302 max-age 240
14303
14304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143057. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14306----------------------------------
14307
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014308HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014309client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14310The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14311these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14312but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14313data called patterns.
14314
14315
143167.1. ACL basics
14317---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014318
14319The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14320content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14321from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14322simple :
14323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014324 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014325 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014326 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14327 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014329The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14330adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014331
14332In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014334 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014335
14336This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14337Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14338and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014339an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14340conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14341as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14342are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014343
14344ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14345'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14346which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14347
14348There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14349performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014351The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14352specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14353this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014354methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14355ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014356
14357Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14358 - boolean
14359 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14360 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14361 - string
14362 - data block
14363
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014364Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14365converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14366would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14367The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14368which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14369
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014370Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14371keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14372fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14373which are summarized in the table below :
14374
14375 +---------------------+-----------------+
14376 | Sample or converter | Default |
14377 | output type | matching method |
14378 +---------------------+-----------------+
14379 | boolean | bool |
14380 +---------------------+-----------------+
14381 | integer | int |
14382 +---------------------+-----------------+
14383 | ip | ip |
14384 +---------------------+-----------------+
14385 | string | str |
14386 +---------------------+-----------------+
14387 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14388 +---------------------+-----------------+
14389
14390Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14391matching method, see below.
14392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014393The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14394 - boolean
14395 - integer or integer range
14396 - IP address / network
14397 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14398 - regular expression
14399 - hex block
14400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014401The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14402
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014403 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14404 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014405 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014406 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014407 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014408 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014409 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014411The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14412read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14413if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14414lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14415will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14416beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14417a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14418lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14419exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14420
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014421The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14422parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14423ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14424a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14425check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14426
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014427The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14428socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14429file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014431Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14432loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14433
14434 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14435
14436In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14437the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14438case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14439as well.
14440
14441The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14442sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14443do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14444methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14445is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014446obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014447followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14448default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14449that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14450string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14451
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014452The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14453By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14454string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14455resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14456server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014457waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014458flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14459function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014461There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14462sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14463be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014464
14465 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14466 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014467 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14468 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14469 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14470 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014471
14472 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14473 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014474 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014475
14476 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014477 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014478
14479 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014480 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014481
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014482 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014483 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14484
14485 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14486 binary or string samples.
14487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014488 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14489 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014491 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14492 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14493 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014495 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14496 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014498 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14499 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014501 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14502 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014504 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14505 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014506 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014508 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14509 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14510 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014511
14512For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14513request, it is possible to do :
14514
14515 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14516
14517In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14518buffer, one would use the following acl :
14519
14520 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14521
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014522On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14523possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14524
14525 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014527All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14528criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14529method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14530to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14531criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14532the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014534If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014535the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14536For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014538 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14539 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14540 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14541 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014542
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014543
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014544The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14545types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14546combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14547brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14548default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014550 +-------------------------------------------------+
14551 | Input sample type |
14552 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014553 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014554 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14555 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14556 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014557 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014558 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014559 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014560 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014561 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014562 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014563 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014564 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014565 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014566 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014567 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014568 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014569 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014570 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014571 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014572 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014573 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014574 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014575 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014576 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014577 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014578 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14579 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14580 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014581
14582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145837.1.1. Matching booleans
14584------------------------
14585
14586In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14587Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14588When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14589that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14590
14591Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14592return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14593"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14594
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200145967.1.2. Matching integers
14597------------------------
14598
14599Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14600enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14601to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14602
14603Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14604matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14605lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014606
14607For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14608unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14609representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14610
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014611As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14612two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14613instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14614ranges and operators.
14615
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014616For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014617operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14618Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14619of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014621Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014622
14623 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14624 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14625 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14626 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14627 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14628
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014629For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014630
14631 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14632
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014633This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14634
14635 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14636
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146387.1.3. Matching strings
14639-----------------------
14640
14641String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14642different forms :
14643
14644 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014645 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014646
14647 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014648 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014649
14650 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14651 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14652
14653 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14654 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14655
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014656 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014657 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14658 matches.
14659
14660 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14661 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14662 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014663
14664String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14665exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14666characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14667string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14668to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014669before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014670
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014671Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14672(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14673Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14674
14675Example:
14676 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14677 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14678
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14681---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014682
14683Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14684they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14685possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14686passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14687the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014688the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14689match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014690
14691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146927.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14693-------------------------------------
14694
14695It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14696not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14697a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14698to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14699digits may be used upper or lower case.
14700
14701Example :
14702 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14703 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14704
14705
147067.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14707---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014708
14709IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14710netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14711within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014712host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014713difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14714at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14715does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14716parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014717
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014718The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14719abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14720
14721 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14722 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14723 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14724 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14725 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14726 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14727 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14728 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14729
14730Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14731192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14732
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014733IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14734Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14735trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14736IPv6 patterns.
14737
14738HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14739following situations :
14740 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14741 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14742 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14743 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14744 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14745 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14746 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14747 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14748 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14749 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014751
147527.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14753----------------------------------
14754
14755Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14756combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14757
14758 - AND (implicit)
14759 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14760 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014762A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014764 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014766Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14767indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014769For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14770"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14771requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14772is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14773
14774 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014775 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14776 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14777 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014778
14779To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14780and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14781
14782 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14783 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14784 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14785 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14786
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014787 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014788 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14789 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14790 use_backend www if host_www
14791
14792It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14793expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14794be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14795the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14796
14797 The following rule :
14798
14799 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014800 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014801
14802 Can also be written that way :
14803
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014804 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014805
14806It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14807to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14808simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14809sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14810good use is the following :
14811
14812 With named ACLs :
14813
14814 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14815 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14816 monitor fail if site_dead
14817
14818 With anonymous ACLs :
14819
14820 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14821
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014822See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14823keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014824
14825
148267.3. Fetching samples
14827---------------------
14828
14829Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14830against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14831sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14832ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14833of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14834available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14835
14836This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14837Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14838compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14839deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14840
14841The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14842matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14843method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14844indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14845
14846As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14847when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14848mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14849the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14850ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14851
14852Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14853multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14854when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014855incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14856are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014857is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14858all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14859
14860Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14861 - name
14862 - name(arg1)
14863 - name(arg1,arg2)
14864
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014865
148667.3.1. Converters
14867-----------------
14868
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014869Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14870of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14871is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14872was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014873has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014874unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14875
14876These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14877sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14878the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014879support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014880
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014881A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14882support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14883supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14884(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14885bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014887The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014888
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001488951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14890 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14891 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14892 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14893 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14894 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14895
14896 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014897 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14898 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014899 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14900 frontend http-in
14901 bind *:8081
14902 default_backend servers
14903 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14904 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14905
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014906add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014907 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014908 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014909 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14910 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014911 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014912 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14913 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14914 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14915 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014916 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014917 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014918
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014919aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14920 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14921 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14922 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14923 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14924 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14925 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14926
14927 Example:
14928 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14929 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14930
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014931and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014932 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014933 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014934 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14935 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014936 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014937 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14938 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14939 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14940 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014941 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014942 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014943
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014944b64dec
14945 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14946 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14947
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014948base64
14949 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014950 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014951 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14952
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014953bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014954 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014955 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014956 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014957 presence of a flag).
14958
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014959bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14960 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14961 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014962 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014963
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014964concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14965 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14966 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14967 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14968 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14969 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14970 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14971 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14972 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14973 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14974 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014975 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014976 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014977 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14978 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014979
14980 Example:
14981 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14982 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14983 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014984 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014985 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14986
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014987cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014988 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14989 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014990
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014991crc32([<avalanche>])
14992 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14993 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14994 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14995 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14996 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14997 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14998 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14999 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15000 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15001 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015002 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15003
15004crc32c([<avalanche>])
15005 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15006 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15007 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15008 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15009 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15010 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15011 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15012 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015013
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015014cut_crlf
15015 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15016 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15017 updated.
15018
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015019da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015020 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15021 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15022 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15023 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015024 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015025 configuration language.
15026
15027 Example:
15028 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015029 bind *:8881
15030 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015031 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015032
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015033debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15034 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15035 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15036 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15037 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15038 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15039 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15040 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15041 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15042 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15043 printable sample types.
15044
15045 Example:
15046 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015047
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015048digest(<algorithm>)
15049 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15050 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15051
15052 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15053 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15054
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015055div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015056 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15057 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015058 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015059 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15060 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015061 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015062 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15063 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15064 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15065 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015066 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015067 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015068
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015069djb2([<avalanche>])
15070 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15071 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15072 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15073 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15074 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15075 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15076 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015077 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15078 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015079
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015080even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015081 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015082 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15083
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015084field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15085 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15086 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15087 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15088 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15089 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15090 fields.
15091
15092 Example :
15093 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15094 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15095 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15096 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15097 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015098
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015099hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015100 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015101 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015102 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015103 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015104
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015105hex2i
15106 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015107 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015108
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015109htonl
15110 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15111 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15112 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15113 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15114
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015115hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15116 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15117 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15118 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15119 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15120
15121 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15122 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15123
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015124http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015125 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15126 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015127 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15128 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15129 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15130 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15131 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15132 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15133 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15134 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015135
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015136iif(<true>,<false>)
15137 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15138 string otherwise.
15139
15140 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015141 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015142
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015143in_table(<table>)
15144 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15145 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15146 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015147 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015148 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15149
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015150ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15151 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015152 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015153 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15154 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15155 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15156 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15157 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015158
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015159json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015160 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015161 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015162 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015163 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15164 of errors:
15165 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15166 bytes, ...)
15167 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15168 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15169
15170 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15171 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15172 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15173 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15174 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15175 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015176 - "ascii" : never fails;
15177 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15178 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015179 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015180 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015181 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15182 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15183
15184 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015185 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015186
15187 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015188 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015189 capture request header user-agent len 150
15190 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015191
15192 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15193 GET / HTTP/1.0
15194 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15195
15196 Output log:
15197 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15198
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015199language(<value>[,<default>])
15200 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15201 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15202 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15203 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15204 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15205 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15206 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15207 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15208 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015209 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015210 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15211 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015212
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015213 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015214
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015215 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15216 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015217
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015218 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15219 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15220 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15221 use_backend spanish if es
15222 use_backend french if fr
15223 use_backend english if en
15224 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015225
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015226length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015227 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15228 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15229 type. The result is of type integer.
15230
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015231lower
15232 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15233 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15234 type. The result is of type string.
15235
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015236ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15237 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15238 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15239 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15240 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15241 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15242 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15243
15244 Example :
15245
15246 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015247 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015248 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15249
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015250ltrim(<chars>)
15251 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15252 representation of the input sample.
15253
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015254map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15255map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15256map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15257 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15258 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15259 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15260 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15261 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15262 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15263 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15264 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015265
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015266 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15267 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15268 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015269
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015270 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015271 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015272
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015273 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15274 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15275 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15276 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015277 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15278 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015279 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15280 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15281 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15282 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15283 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15284 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15285 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15286 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015287 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15288 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15289 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015290 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15291 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15292 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15293 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15294 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015295
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015296 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15297 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15298 the corresponding match text.
15299
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015300 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15301 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15302 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15303 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15304 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015305
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015306 Example :
15307
15308 # this is a comment and is ignored
15309 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15310 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15311 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15312 | | | `---------- value
15313 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15314 | `---------------------------- key
15315 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15316
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015317mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015318 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15319 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015320 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015321 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015322 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015323 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15324 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15325 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15326 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015327 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015328 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015329
15330mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015331 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015332 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15333 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015334 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015335 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015336 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015337 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15338 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15339 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15340 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015341 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015342 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015343
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015344nbsrv
15345 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15346 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15347 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15348 map lookup.
15349
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015350neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015351 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15352 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15353 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15354 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015355
15356not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015357 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015358 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015359 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015360 absence of a flag).
15361
15362odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015363 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015364 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15365
15366or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015367 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015368 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015369 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15370 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015371 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015372 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15373 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15374 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15375 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015376 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015377 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015378
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015379protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15380 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15381 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15382 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15383 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15384 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15385 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15386 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15387 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15388 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15389 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15390 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15391
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015392regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015393 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15394 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15395 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15396 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15397 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15398 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15399 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15400 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15401 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015402 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15403 of characters with other ones.
15404
15405 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15406 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15407 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15408 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15409 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15410 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015411
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015412 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015413
15414 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15415 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15416 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015417 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015418
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015419 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15420 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15421
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015422 # capture groups and backreferences
15423 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015424 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015425 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15426
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015427capture-req(<id>)
15428 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15429 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15430
15431 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015432 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15433 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015434
15435capture-res(<id>)
15436 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15437 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15438
15439 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015440 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15441 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015442
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015443rtrim(<chars>)
15444 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15445 of the input sample.
15446
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015447sdbm([<avalanche>])
15448 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15449 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15450 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15451 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15452 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15453 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15454 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015455 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15456 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015457
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015458secure_memcmp(<var>)
15459 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15460 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15461 match.
15462
15463 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15464 performed in constant time.
15465
15466 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15467 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15468
15469 Example :
15470
15471 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15472 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15473 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15474 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15475
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015476set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015477 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15478 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15479 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015480 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015481 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15482 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015483 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015484 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15485 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015486 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015487 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015488
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015489sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015490 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015491 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15492
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015493sha2([<bits>])
15494 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15495 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15496
15497 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15498 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15499
15500 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15501 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15502
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015503srv_queue
15504 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15505 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15506 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15507 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15508 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15509
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015510strcmp(<var>)
15511 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15512 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15513 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15514 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15515 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15516 shorter).
15517
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015518 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15519 strings in constant time.
15520
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015521 Example :
15522
15523 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15524 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15525 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15526
15527
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015528sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015529 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15530 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015531 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015532 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15533 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015534 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015535 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15536 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015537 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015538 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15539 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015540 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015541 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015542
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015543table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15544 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15545 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15546 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15547 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15548 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15549 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15550
15551
15552table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15553 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15554 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15555 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15556 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15557 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15558 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15559
15560table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15561 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15562 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015563 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015564 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15565 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15566
15567table_conn_cur(<table>)
15568 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15569 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15570 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15571 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15572 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15573
15574table_conn_rate(<table>)
15575 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15576 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15577 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15578 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15579 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15580
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015581table_gpt0(<table>)
15582 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15583 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15584 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15585 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15586 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15587
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015588table_gpc0(<table>)
15589 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15590 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15591 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15592 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15593 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15594
15595table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15596 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15597 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15598 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15599 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15600 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15601 sample fetch keyword.
15602
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015603table_gpc1(<table>)
15604 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15605 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15606 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15607 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15608 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15609
15610table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15611 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15612 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15613 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15614 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15615 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15616 sample fetch keyword.
15617
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015618table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15619 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15620 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015621 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015622 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15623 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15624
15625table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15626 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15627 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15628 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15629 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15630 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15631 keyword.
15632
15633table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15634 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15635 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015636 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015637 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15638 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15639
15640table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15641 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15642 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15643 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15644 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15645 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15646 keyword.
15647
15648table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15649 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15650 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015651 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015652 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15653 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15654 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15655 keyword.
15656
15657table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15658 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15659 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015660 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015661 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15662 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15663 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15664 keyword.
15665
15666table_server_id(<table>)
15667 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15668 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15669 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15670 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15671 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15672 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15673
15674table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15675 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15676 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015677 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015678 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15679 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15680 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15681 keyword.
15682
15683table_sess_rate(<table>)
15684 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15685 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15686 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15687 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15688 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15689 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15690 keyword.
15691
15692table_trackers(<table>)
15693 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15694 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15695 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15696 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15697 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15698 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15699 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15700 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15701 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15702 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15703
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015704upper
15705 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15706 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15707 type. The result is of type string.
15708
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015709url_dec([<in_form>])
15710 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15711 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15712 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15713 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15714 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15715 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015716
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015717ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015718 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015719 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15720 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15721 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015722 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15723 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15724 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15725 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015726 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015727 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15728 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015729
15730 Example:
15731 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15732 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15733
15734 message Point {
15735 int32 latitude = 1;
15736 int32 longitude = 2;
15737 }
15738
15739 message PPoint {
15740 Point point = 59;
15741 }
15742
15743 message Rectangle {
15744 // One corner of the rectangle.
15745 PPoint lo = 48;
15746 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15747 PPoint hi = 49;
15748 }
15749
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015750 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15751 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15752 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015753
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015754 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15755 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015756 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015757 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15758
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015759 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015760
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015761 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015762
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015763 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15764 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15765 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015766
15767 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15768 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15769 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15770
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015771 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15772 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15773 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015774
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015775
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015776unset-var(<var name>)
15777 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15778 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15779 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15780 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15781 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15782 response),
15783 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15784 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15785 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15786 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15787
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015788utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15789 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15790 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15791 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15792 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15793 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15794 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15795
15796 Example :
15797
15798 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015799 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015800 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15801
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015802word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15803 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15804 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15805 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015806 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015807 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15808 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15809
15810 Example :
15811 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15812 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15813 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15814 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15815 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015816 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015817
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015818wt6([<avalanche>])
15819 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15820 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15821 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15822 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15823 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15824 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15825 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015826 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15827 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015828
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015829xor(<value>)
15830 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015831 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015832 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015833 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015834 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015835 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15836 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015837 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015838 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15839 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015840 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015841 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015842
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015843xxh32([<seed>])
15844 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15845 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15846 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15847 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15848 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15849 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15850 as cryptographically secure.
15851
15852xxh64([<seed>])
15853 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15854 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15855 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15856 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15857 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15858 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15859 as cryptographically secure.
15860
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015861
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158627.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015863--------------------------------------------
15864
15865A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15866not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15867"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15868The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15869
15870always_false : boolean
15871 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15872 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15873
15874always_true : boolean
15875 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15876 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15877
15878avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015879 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015880 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15881 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15882 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15883 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15884 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15885 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15886 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15887 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15888 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15889 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15890 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15891 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15892 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015894be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015895 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15896 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15897 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15898 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015899 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15900
15901be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15902 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15903 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15904 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15905 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15906 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015907 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15908 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015909
15910 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15911 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15912 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015914be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15915 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15916 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15917 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015918 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015919 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15920 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015921
15922 Example :
15923 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15924 backend dynamic
15925 mode http
15926 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15927 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015928
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015929bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015930 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15931 of the string.
15932
15933bool(<bool>) : bool
15934 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15935 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015937connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15938 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015939 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15941 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015942
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015943 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015944 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015945 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15946
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015947 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15948 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015949
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015950 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015951 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015952 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015953 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015954 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015955 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015956 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015957
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015958 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15959 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015960 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015961 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015962
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015963cpu_calls : integer
15964 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15965 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15966 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15967 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15968 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15969 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15970
15971cpu_ns_avg : integer
15972 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15973 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15974 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15975 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15976 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15977 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15978 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15979 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15980 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15981 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15982 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15983
15984cpu_ns_tot : integer
15985 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15986 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15987 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15988 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15989 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15990 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15991 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15992 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15993 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15994 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15995 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15996 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15997 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15998
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015999date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016000 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016001
16002 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16003 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16004 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016005 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16006
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016007 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16008 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16009 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16010 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16011 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16012
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016013 Example :
16014
16015 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16016 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016017
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016018 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16019 # millisecond granularity
16020 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16021
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016022date_us : integer
16023 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16024 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16025 from the same timeval structure.
16026
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016027distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16028 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16029 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16030 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16031 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16032 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16033 list of supported tokens.
16034
16035distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16036 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16037 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16038 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16039 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16040 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16041 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16042 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16043 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16044 supported tokens.
16045
16046 Example :
16047 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16048 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16049 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16050 # send large files to the big farm
16051 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16052
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016053env(<name>) : string
16054 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16055 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16056 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16057 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16058 certain way.
16059
16060 Examples :
16061 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16062 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16063
16064 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16065 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016067fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16068 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016069 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16070 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016071 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16072 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016073 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016074 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16075 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016076
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016077fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16078 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16079 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16080 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016082fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16083 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16084 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16085 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16086 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16087 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16088 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16089 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16090 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016091
16092 Example :
16093 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16094 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16095 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16096 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16097 frontend mail
16098 bind :25
16099 mode tcp
16100 maxconn 100
16101 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16102 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16103 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16104 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016105
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016106hostname : string
16107 Returns the system hostname.
16108
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016109int(<integer>) : signed integer
16110 Returns a signed integer.
16111
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016112ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16113 Returns an ipv4.
16114
16115ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16116 Returns an ipv6.
16117
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016118lat_ns_avg : integer
16119 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16120 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16121 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16122 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16123 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16124 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16125 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16126 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16127 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016128 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16129 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16130 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16131 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16132 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16133 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016134
16135lat_ns_tot : integer
16136 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16137 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16138 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16139 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16140 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16141 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16142 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16143 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16144 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016145 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16146 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16147 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16148 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16149 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016150 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16151 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16152 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16153 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16154 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16155 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16156
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016157meth(<method>) : method
16158 Returns a method.
16159
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016160nbproc : integer
16161 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16162 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16163 and debugging purposes.
16164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016165nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16166 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16167 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16168 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016169 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16170 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16171 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016172
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016173prio_class : integer
16174 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16175 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16176 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16177
16178prio_offset : integer
16179 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16180 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16181 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16182 set-priority-offset".
16183
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016184proc : integer
16185 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16186 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16187 debugging purposes.
16188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016189queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016190 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16191 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16192 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016193 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16194 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16195 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16196 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16197 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16198
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016199rand([<range>]) : integer
16200 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16201 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16202 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16203 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16204 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16205
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016206uuid([<version>]) : string
16207 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16208 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16209 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016211srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16212 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16213 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16214 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16215 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16216 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016217 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16218 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16219
16220srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16221 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16222 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16223 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16224 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16225 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16226 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16227 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16228
16229 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16230 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231
16232srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16233 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16234 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16235 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016236 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016237 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16238 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16239 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16240
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016241srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16242 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16243 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16244 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16245 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16246 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16247 fetch methods.
16248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016249srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16250 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16251 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016252 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016253 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16254 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016255 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016256 overloading servers).
16257
16258 Example :
16259 # Redirect to a separate back
16260 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16261 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16262 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16263
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016264srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16265 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16266 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16267 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16268
16269srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16270 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16271 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16272 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16273
16274srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16275 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16276 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16277 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16278
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016279stopping : boolean
16280 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16281 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16282 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16283
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016284str(<string>) : string
16285 Returns a string.
16286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016287table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16288 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16289 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16290
16291table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16292 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16293 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16294 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16295
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016296thread : integer
16297 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16298 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16299 and debugging purposes.
16300
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016301var(<var-name>) : undefined
16302 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016303 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16304 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016305 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016306 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16307 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016308 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016309 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16310 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016311 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016312 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016313
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163147.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016315----------------------------------
16316
16317The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16318closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16319methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16320sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16321TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016322the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16323counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016324"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16325used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16326can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16327Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16328table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16329tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16330currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016331
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016332bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016333 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16334 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16335 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016337be_id : integer
16338 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016339 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16340 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016341
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016342be_name : string
16343 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016344 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16345 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016347dst : ip
16348 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16349 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16350 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16351 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016352 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16353 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16354 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16355 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16356 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16357 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016358
16359dst_conn : integer
16360 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16361 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16362 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16363 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16364 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16365 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16366 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16367 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016368
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016369dst_is_local : boolean
16370 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16371 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16372 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16373 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016374 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016375 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16376 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16377 it only once per connection.
16378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016379dst_port : integer
16380 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16381 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16382 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16383 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16384 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16385 an HTTP header.
16386
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016387fc_http_major : integer
16388 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16389 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16390 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16391
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016392fc_pp_authority : string
16393 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16394 if any.
16395
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016396fc_pp_unique_id : string
16397 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16398 if any.
16399
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016400fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16401 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16402 header.
16403
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016404fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16405 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16406 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16407 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16408 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16409 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16410 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16411
16412fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16413 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16414 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16415 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16416 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16417 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16418 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16419
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016420fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016421 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16422 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16423 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16424 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16425
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016426fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016427 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16428 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16429 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16430 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16431
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016432fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016433 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16434 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16435 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16436 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16437
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016438fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016439 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16440 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16441 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16442 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16443
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016444fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016445 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16446 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16447 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16448 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16449
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016450fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016451 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16452 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16453 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16454 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16455
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016456fe_defbe : string
16457 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16458 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016460fe_id : integer
16461 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016462 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016463 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16464
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016465fe_name : string
16466 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16467 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16468 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16469
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016470sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016471sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16472sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16473sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016474 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16475 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16476 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16477
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016478sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016479sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16480sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16481sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016482 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16483 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16484 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16485
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016486sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016487sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16488sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16489sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016490 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16491 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016492 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16493 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16494 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016495
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016496 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016497 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16498 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016499 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16500 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16501 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016502 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16503 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16504
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016505sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16506sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16507sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16508sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16509 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16510 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16511 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16512 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16513 when a first ACL was verified.
16514
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016515sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016516sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16517sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16518sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016519 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016520 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16521
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016522sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016523sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16524sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16525sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016526 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16527 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16528 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16529
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016530sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016531sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16532sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16533sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016534 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16535 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16536 See also src_conn_rate.
16537
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016538sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016539sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16540sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16541sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016542 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016543 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016544
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016545sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16546sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16547sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16548sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16549 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16550 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16551
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016552sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16553sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16554sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16555sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16556 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16557 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16558
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016559sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016560sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16561sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16562sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016563 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16564 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16565 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016566 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16567 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16568 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016569
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016570sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16571sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16572sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16573sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16574 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16575 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16576 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16577 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16578 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16579 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16580
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016581sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016582sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16583sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16584sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016585 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016586 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16587 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16588
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016589sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016590sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16591sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16592sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016593 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16594 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16595 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16596 src_http_err_rate.
16597
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016598sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016599sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16600sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16601sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016602 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016603 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16604 src_http_req_cnt.
16605
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016606sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016607sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16608sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16609sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016610 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16611 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16612 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16613 src_http_req_rate.
16614
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016615sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016616sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16617sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16618sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016619 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016620 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16621 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16622 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16623 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016624
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016625 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016626 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16627 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016628 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16629
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016630sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16631sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16632sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16633sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16634 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16635 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16636 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16637 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16638 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16639
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016640sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016641sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16642sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16643sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016644 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16645 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16646 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016647
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016648sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016649sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16650sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16651sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016652 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16653 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16654 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016655
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016656sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016657sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16658sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16659sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016660 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016661 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16662 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16663 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016664 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016665 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16666
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016667sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016668sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16669sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16670sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016671 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16672 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16673 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16674 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16675 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016676 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016677
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016678sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016679sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16680sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16681sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016682 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16683 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16684 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16685
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016686sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016687sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16688sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16689sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016690 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16691 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016692 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016693 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16694 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016695 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16696 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16697 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016699so_id : integer
16700 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16701 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16702 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016703
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016704so_name : string
16705 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16706 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16707 strings instead of integers.
16708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016709src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016710 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016711 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16712 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16713 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016714 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16715 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16716 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016717 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16718 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16719 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16720 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16721 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16722 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16723 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016724
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016725 Example:
16726 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16727 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016729src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16730 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16731 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16732 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016733 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016735src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16736 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16737 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016738 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016739 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016741src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16742 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16743 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16744 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16745 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16746 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16747 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016748
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016749 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016750 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16751 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16752 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16753 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016754 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016755 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16756 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16757
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016758src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16759 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16760 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16761 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16762 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16763 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16764 was verified.
16765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016766src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016767 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016768 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016769 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016770 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016772src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016773 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016774 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16775 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016776 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016778src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16779 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16780 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16781 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016782 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016784src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016785 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016786 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016787 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016788 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016789
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016790src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16791 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16792 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16793 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16794 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16795
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016796src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16797 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16798 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16799 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16800 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016802src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016803 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016804 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016805 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16806 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016807 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16808 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16809 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016810
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016811src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16812 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16813 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16814 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16815 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16816 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16817 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16818 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016820src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016821 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016822 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016823 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016824 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016825 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016827src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16828 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16829 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16830 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16831 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016832 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016834src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016835 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016836 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16837 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016838 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016840src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16841 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16842 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16843 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016844 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016845 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016847src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16848 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16849 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16850 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016851 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016852 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16853 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016854
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016855 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016856 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016857 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016858 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016859
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016860src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16861 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16862 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16863 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16864 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16865 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16866 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16867
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016868src_is_local : boolean
16869 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16870 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16871 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16872 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016873 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016874 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16875 once per connection.
16876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016877src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016878 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16879 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16880 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16881 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16882 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016884src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016885 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16886 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16887 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16888 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16889 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016891src_port : integer
16892 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16893 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16894 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16895 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016897src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016898 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016899 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16900 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16901 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016902 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016904src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16905 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16906 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16907 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16908 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016909 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016911src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16912 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16913 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16914 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16915 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16916 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16917 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16918 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16919 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016920
16921 Example :
16922 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16923 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16924 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16925 listen ssh
16926 bind :22
16927 mode tcp
16928 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016929 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016930 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016931 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016933srv_id : integer
16934 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16935 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016936 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016937
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016938srv_name : string
16939 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16940 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016941 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016942
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169437.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016944----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016946The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16947closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16948when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16949usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016950future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016951
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001695251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16953 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16954 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16955 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16956 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16957 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16958
16959 Example :
16960 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16961 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16962 # the request.
16963 frontend http-in
16964 bind *:8081
16965 default_backend servers
16966 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16967 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16968
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016969ssl_bc : boolean
16970 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16971 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016972 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16973 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016974
16975ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16976 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016977 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16978 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016979
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016980ssl_bc_alpn : string
16981 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16982 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016983 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016984 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16985 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16986 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16987 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16988 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016989 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16990 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016991
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016992ssl_bc_cipher : string
16993 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016994 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16995 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016996
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016997ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16998 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16999 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17000 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017001 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017002
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017003ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17004 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17005 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017006 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17007 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017008
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017009ssl_bc_npn : string
17010 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17011 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017012 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017013 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17014 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17015 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17016 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017017 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17018 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017019
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017020ssl_bc_protocol : string
17021 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017022 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17023 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017024
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017025ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017026 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017027 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017028 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17029 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017030
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017031ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17032 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17033 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17034 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017035 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017036
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017037ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17038 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17039 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017040 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17041 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017042
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017043ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17044 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17045 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17046 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017047 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017048
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017049ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17050 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017051 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17052 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017054ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17055 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17056 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17057 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17058 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17059 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017061ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17062 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17063 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17064 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17065 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017066
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017067ssl_c_der : binary
17068 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17069 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17070 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17071
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017072ssl_c_der_chain : binary
17073 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17074 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17075 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17076 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17077 does not support resumed sessions.
17078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017079ssl_c_err : integer
17080 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17081 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17082 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17083 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17084 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017085
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017086ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017087 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17088 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17089 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17090 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17091 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17092 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17093 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17094 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017095 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17096 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17097 LDAP v3.
17098 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17099 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017101ssl_c_key_alg : string
17102 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17103 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17104 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017106ssl_c_notafter : string
17107 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17108 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17109 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017111ssl_c_notbefore : string
17112 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17113 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17114 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017115
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017116ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017117 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17118 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17119 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17120 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17121 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17122 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17123 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17124 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017125 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17126 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17127 LDAP v3.
17128 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17129 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017131ssl_c_serial : binary
17132 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17133 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17134 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017136ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17137 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17138 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17139 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017140 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17141 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17142
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017143 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017144 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017146ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17147 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17148 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17149 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017151ssl_c_used : boolean
17152 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17153 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017155ssl_c_verify : integer
17156 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17157 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17158 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17159 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017161ssl_c_version : integer
17162 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17163 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017164
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017165ssl_f_der : binary
17166 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17167 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17168 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17169
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017170ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017171 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17172 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17173 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17174 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017175 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017176 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17177 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17178 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017179 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17180 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17181 LDAP v3.
17182 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17183 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017185ssl_f_key_alg : string
17186 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17187 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17188 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017190ssl_f_notafter : string
17191 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17192 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17193 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017195ssl_f_notbefore : string
17196 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17197 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17198 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017199
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017200ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017201 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17202 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17203 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17204 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17205 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17206 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17207 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17208 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017209 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17210 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17211 LDAP v3.
17212 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17213 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017215ssl_f_serial : binary
17216 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17217 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17218 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017219
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017220ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17221 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17222 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17223 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017225ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17226 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17227 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17228 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017230ssl_f_version : integer
17231 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17232 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17233
17234ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017235 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17236 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17237 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017239 Example :
17240 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17241 listen http-https
17242 bind :80
17243 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17244 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17245
17246ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17247 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17248 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17249
17250ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017251 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017252 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17253 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17254 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17255 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17256 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17257 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17258 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17259 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017261ssl_fc_cipher : string
17262 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17263 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017264
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017265ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17266 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17267 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017268 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017269
17270ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17271 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17272 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017273 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017274
17275ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17276 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17277 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17278 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017279 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017280 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017281
17282ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17283 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17284 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017285 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017286
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017287ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17288 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17289 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17290 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17291
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017292ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17293 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17294 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17295 transport layer.
17296 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17297 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17298 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17299 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17300
17301ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17302 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17303 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17304 transport layer.
17305 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17306 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17307 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17308 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17309
17310ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17311 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17312 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17313 transport layer.
17314 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17315 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17316 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17317 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17318
17319ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17320 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17321 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17322 transport layer.
17323 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17324 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17325 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17326 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17327
17328ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17329 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17330 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17331 transport layer.
17332 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17333 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17334 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17335 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017337ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017338 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17339 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017340 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17341 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17342 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17343 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017344
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017345ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17346 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17347 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17348 wait until the handshake happened.
17349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017350ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17351 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017352 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17353 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017354 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017355 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017356
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017357ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017358 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017359 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17360 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017362ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017363 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017364 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17365 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17366 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17367 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17368 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17369 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17370 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017372ssl_fc_protocol : string
17373 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17374 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017375
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017376ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017377 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017378 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17379 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017380
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017381ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17382 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17383 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17384 transport layer.
17385 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17386 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17387 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17388 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17389
17390ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17391 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17392 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17393 transport layer.
17394 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17395 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17396 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17397 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17398
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017399ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17400 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17401 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17402 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017404ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17405 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17406 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17407 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17408 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017409
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017410ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17411 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17412 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17413 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17414 BoringSSL.
17415
17416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017417ssl_fc_sni : string
17418 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17419 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17420 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17421 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17422 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17423
17424 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17425 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17426 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017427 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017428 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017430 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017431 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17432 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017434ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17435 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17436 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017437
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017438ssl_s_der : binary
17439 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17440 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17441 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17442
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017443ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17444 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17445 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17446 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17447 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17448 does not support resumed sessions.
17449
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017450ssl_s_key_alg : string
17451 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17452 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17453 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17454
17455ssl_s_notafter : string
17456 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17457 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17458 transport layer.
17459
17460ssl_s_notbefore : string
17461 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17462 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17463 transport layer.
17464
17465ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17466 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17467 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17468 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17469 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17470 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17471 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017472 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17473 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017474 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17475 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17476 LDAP v3.
17477 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17478 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17479
17480ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17481 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17482 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17483 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17484 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17485 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17486 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017487 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17488 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017489 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17490 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17491 LDAP v3.
17492 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17493 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17494
17495ssl_s_serial : binary
17496 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17497 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17498 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17499
17500ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17501 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17502 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17503 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17504
17505ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17506 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17507 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17508 layer.
17509
17510ssl_s_version : integer
17511 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17512 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017513
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175147.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017515------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017517Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17518sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17519only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17520For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17521be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17522can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17523sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17524for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17525content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017527payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017528 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017529 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17530 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017532payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17533 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017534 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017535 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017536
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017537req.hdrs : string
17538 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17539 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17540 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17541 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17542
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017543req.hdrs_bin : binary
17544 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17545 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17546 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17547 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17548 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17549 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17550
17551 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17552
17553 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17554 str: <int:length><bytes>
17555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017556req.len : integer
17557req_len : integer (deprecated)
17558 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17559 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17560 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17561 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17562 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17563 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17564 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17565 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017567req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17568 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017569 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17570 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17571 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17572 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017574 ACL alternatives :
17575 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017577req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17578 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17579 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17580 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17581 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017583 ACL alternatives :
17584 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017586 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017588req.proto_http : boolean
17589req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17590 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17591 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17592 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17593 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17594 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17595 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17596 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017598 Example:
17599 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17600 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17601 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017602 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017604req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17605rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17606 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17607 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17608 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17609 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17610 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17611 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17612 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017614 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17615 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17616 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17617 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17618 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17619 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017621 ACL derivatives :
17622 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017624 Example :
17625 listen tse-farm
17626 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17627 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17628 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17629 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17630 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17631 persist rdp-cookie
17632 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17633 # This is only useful makes sense if
17634 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17635 stick-table type string size 204800
17636 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17637 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17638 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017640 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17641 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017643req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17644rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17645 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17646 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17647 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17648 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017650 ACL derivatives :
17651 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017652
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017653req.ssl_alpn : string
17654 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17655 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17656 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17657 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17658 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17659 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017660 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017661
17662 Examples :
17663 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17664 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17665 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017666 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017667 default_backend bk_default
17668
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017669req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17670 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17671 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017672 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17673 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17674 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17675 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17676 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017678req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17679req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17680 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17681 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17682 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17683 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17684 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17685 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17686 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017688req.ssl_sni : string
17689req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17690 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17691 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17692 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17693 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17694 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020017695 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
17696 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
17697 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
17698 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
17699 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
17700 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
17701 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
17702 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
17703 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017705 ACL derivatives :
17706 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017708 Examples :
17709 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17710 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17711 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17712 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17713 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017714
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017715req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17716 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17717 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17718 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17719 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17720 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17721 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17722 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17723 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17724 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017726req.ssl_ver : integer
17727req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17728 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17729 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17730 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17731 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17732 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17733 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17734 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017735 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017736 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017738 ACL derivatives :
17739 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017740
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017741res.len : integer
17742 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17743 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17744 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17745 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17746 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17747 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17748 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017749 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017751res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17752 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017753 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017754 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017755 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017756 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017758res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17759 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17760 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17761 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017762 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17763 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017765 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017766
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017767res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17768rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17769 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17770 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17771 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17772 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17773 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17774 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17775 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017777wait_end : boolean
17778 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17779 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017780 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017781 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17782 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017783 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017784 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17785 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017787 Examples :
17788 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17789 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17790 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017792 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17793 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17794 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17795 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17796 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17797 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17798 tcp-request content reject
17799
17800
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200178017.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017802--------------------------------------
17803
17804It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17805This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17806data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17807its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17808HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17809content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17810to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17811more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17812response are indexed.
17813
17814base : string
17815 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17816 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17817 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17818 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17819 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17820 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17821 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17822 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17823
17824 ACL derivatives :
17825 base : exact string match
17826 base_beg : prefix match
17827 base_dir : subdir match
17828 base_dom : domain match
17829 base_end : suffix match
17830 base_len : length match
17831 base_reg : regex match
17832 base_sub : substring match
17833
17834base32 : integer
17835 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17836 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17837 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017838 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17839 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17840 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017841
17842base32+src : binary
17843 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17844 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17845 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17846 per-URL counters.
17847
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017848capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17849 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17850 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17851 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17852
17853capture.req.method : string
17854 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17855 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17856 because it's allocated.
17857
17858capture.req.uri : string
17859 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17860 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17861 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17862 allocated.
17863
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017864capture.req.ver : string
17865 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17866 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17867 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17868
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017869capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17870 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17871 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17872 The first entry is an index of 0.
17873 See also: "capture response header"
17874
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017875capture.res.ver : string
17876 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17877 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17878 persistent flag.
17879
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017880req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017881 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17882 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17883 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017884
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017885req.body_param([<name>) : string
17886 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17887 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17888 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17889 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17890 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17891 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17892 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17893 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17894 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17895 given.
17896
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017897req.body_len : integer
17898 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17899 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017900 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17901 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017902
17903req.body_size : integer
17904 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017905 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17906 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017908req.cook([<name>]) : string
17909cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17910 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17911 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17912 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17913 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17914 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17915 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17916 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17917 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17918
17919 ACL derivatives :
17920 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17921 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17922 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17923 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17924 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17925 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17926 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17927 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017929req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17930cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17931 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17932 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017934req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17935cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17936 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17937 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17938 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17939 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017941cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17942 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17943 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17944 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17945 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017946 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017947 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17948 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17949 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17950 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017952hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17953 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17954 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17955 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17956 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017957 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017959req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17960 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17961 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17962 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17963 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17964 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17965 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17966 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17967 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017969req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17970 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17971 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17972 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17973 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017975req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17976 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17977 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17978 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17979 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17980 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17981 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17982 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17983 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017984 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017985 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017986 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017988 ACL derivatives :
17989 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17990 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17991 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17992 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17993 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17994 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17995 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17996 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17997
17998req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17999hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18000 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18001 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18002 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18003 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18004 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18005 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18006 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18007 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18008 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18009
18010req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18011hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18012 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18013 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18014 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18015 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18016 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018017 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018018 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18019 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18020
18021req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18022hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18023 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18024 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18025 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18026 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18027 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18028 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18029 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18030
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018031
18032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018033http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18034 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18035 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18036 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18037 basic auth is supported.
18038
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018039http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18040 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18041 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18042 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18043 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018044 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18045 basic auth is supported.
18046
18047 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018048 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18049 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18050 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18051 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018052
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018053http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018054 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18055 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18056 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018057
18058http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018059 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18060 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18061 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018062
18063http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018064 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18065 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18066 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018068http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018069 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18070 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018071 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18072 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018074method : integer + string
18075 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18076 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18077 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18078 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18079 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18080 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18081 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018083 ACL derivatives :
18084 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018086 Example :
18087 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18088 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18089 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018091path : string
18092 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18093 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18094 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18095 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18096 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018097 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018098 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018100 ACL derivatives :
18101 path : exact string match
18102 path_beg : prefix match
18103 path_dir : subdir match
18104 path_dom : domain match
18105 path_end : suffix match
18106 path_len : length match
18107 path_reg : regex match
18108 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018109
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018110pathq : string
18111 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18112 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18113 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18114 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18115 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18116 result in both cases.
18117
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018118query : string
18119 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18120 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18121 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18122 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018123 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018124 which stops before the question mark.
18125
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018126req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18127 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18128 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18129 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18130 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018132req.ver : string
18133req_ver : string (deprecated)
18134 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18135 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18136 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018138 ACL derivatives :
18139 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018140
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018141res.body : binary
18142 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18143 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18144 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18145 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18146
18147res.body_len : integer
18148 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18149 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18150 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18151 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18152
18153res.body_size : integer
18154 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18155 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18156 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18157 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18158 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18159 based expect rules.
18160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018161res.comp : boolean
18162 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18163 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18164 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018166res.comp_algo : string
18167 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18168 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18169 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018171res.cook([<name>]) : string
18172scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18173 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18174 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018175 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18176 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018178 ACL derivatives :
18179 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018181res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18182scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18183 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18184 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018185 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18186 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018188res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18189scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18190 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18191 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018192 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18193 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018195res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18196 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18197 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18198 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18199 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18200 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18201 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18202 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18203 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018204 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018206res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18207 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18208 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18209 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18210 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018211 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18212 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018214res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18215shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18216 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18217 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18218 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18219 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18220 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18221 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18222 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018223 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18224 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018226 ACL derivatives :
18227 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18228 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18229 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18230 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18231 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18232 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18233 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18234 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18235
18236res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18237shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18238 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18239 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18240 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18241 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018242 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018244res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18245shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18246 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18247 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18248 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18249 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18250 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018251 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18252 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018253
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018254res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18255 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18256 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18257 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018258 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18259 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018261res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18262shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18263 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18264 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18265 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18266 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18267 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018268 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18269 based expect rules.
18270
18271res.hdrs : string
18272 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18273 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18274 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18275 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18276 based expect rules.
18277
18278res.hdrs_bin : binary
18279 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18280 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18281 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18282 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18283 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18284 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18285 (length of 0 for both).
18286
18287 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18288
18289 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18290 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018292res.ver : string
18293resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18294 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018295 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18296 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018298 ACL derivatives :
18299 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018301set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18302 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18303 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018304 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018305 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018307 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18308 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018310status : integer
18311 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18312 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018313 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18314 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018315
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018316unique-id : string
18317 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18318 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18319 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18320 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18321 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18322 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018324url : string
18325 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18326 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18327 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18328 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18329 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18330 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18331 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018333 ACL derivatives :
18334 url : exact string match
18335 url_beg : prefix match
18336 url_dir : subdir match
18337 url_dom : domain match
18338 url_end : suffix match
18339 url_len : length match
18340 url_reg : regex match
18341 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018343url_ip : ip
18344 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18345 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18346 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18347 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18348 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18349 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18350 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018352url_port : integer
18353 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18354 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18355 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18356 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018357
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018358urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18359url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018360 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18361 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018362 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18363 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18364 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18365 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018366 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18367 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018368 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18369 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018371 ACL derivatives :
18372 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18373 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18374 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18375 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18376 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18377 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18378 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18379 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018380
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018382 Example :
18383 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18384 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18385 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18386 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018387
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018388urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018389 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18390 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18391 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018392
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018393url32 : integer
18394 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18395 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18396 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18397 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18398 is an unsigned integer.
18399
18400url32+src : binary
18401 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18402 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18403 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18404
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018405
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200184067.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018407---------------------------------------
18408
18409This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18410used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18411purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18412There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18413or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18414any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18415for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18416
18417internal.htx.data : integer
18418 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18419 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18420
18421internal.htx.free : integer
18422 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18423 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18424
18425internal.htx.free_data : integer
18426 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18427 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18428
18429internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18430 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18431 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18432 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18433
18434internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18435 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18436 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18437
18438internal.htx.size : integer
18439 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18440 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18441
18442internal.htx.used : integer
18443 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18444 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18445 direction.
18446
18447internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18448 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18449 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18450 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18451 of the special value :
18452 * head : The oldest inserted block
18453 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018454 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018455
18456internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18457 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18458 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18459 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18460 integer or one of the special value :
18461 * head : The oldest inserted block
18462 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018463 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018464
18465internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18466 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18467 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18468 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18469 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18470
18471 * head : The oldest inserted block
18472 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018473 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018474
18475internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18476 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18477 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18478 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18479 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18480
18481 * head : The oldest inserted block
18482 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018483 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018484
18485internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18486 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18487 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18488 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18489 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18490
18491 * head : The oldest inserted block
18492 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018493 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018494
18495internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18496 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18497 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18498 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18499 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18500
18501 * head : The oldest inserted block
18502 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018503 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018504
18505internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18506 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18507 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18508 it returns false.
18509
18510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200185117.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018512---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018514Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18515every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018516order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018517
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018518ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18519---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018520FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018521HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018522HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18523HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018524HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18525HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18526HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18527HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18528LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018529METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018530METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018531METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18532METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18533METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18534METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018535METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018536METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018537RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018538REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018539TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018540WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18541---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018542
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185448. Logging
18545----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018546
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018547One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18548provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18549very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18550provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18551state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018552to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018553headers.
18554
18555In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18556about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18557send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18558
18559 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18560 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18561 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18562 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18563 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018564 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018565 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018566
18567The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18568allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18569as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18570while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18571real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18572delay.
18573
18574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185758.1. Log levels
18576---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018577
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018578TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018579source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018580HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18581in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18582track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18583syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18584about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018585
18586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185878.2. Log formats
18588----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018589
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018590HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018591and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18592slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18593options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018594
18595 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18596 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18597 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18598 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18599 extents.
18600
18601 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18602 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18603 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18604 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18605 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18606
18607 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18608 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18609 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18610 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18611 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18612
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018613 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18614 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18615 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18616 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18617
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018618 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18619
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018620Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18621specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18622field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18623servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18624always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18625identifier.
18626
18627Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18628 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18629 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18630 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18631 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18632
18633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186348.2.1. Default log format
18635-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018636
18637This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18638as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18639format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18640
18641 Example :
18642 listen www
18643 mode http
18644 log global
18645 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18646
18647 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18648 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18649 (www/HTTP)
18650
18651 Field Format Extract from the example above
18652 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18653 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18654 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18655 4 'to' to
18656 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18657 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18658
18659Detailed fields description :
18660 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18661 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18662 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18663 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18664 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18665 and processed the connection.
18666 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18667
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018668In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18669"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18670connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18671
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018672It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18673will eventually disappear.
18674
18675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186768.2.2. TCP log format
18677---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018678
18679The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18680is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18681information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18682counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18683emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18684environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18685the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18686sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018687specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18688not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18689fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18690marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018691
18692 Example :
18693 frontend fnt
18694 mode tcp
18695 option tcplog
18696 log global
18697 default_backend bck
18698
18699 backend bck
18700 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18701
18702 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18703 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18704 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18705
18706 Field Format Extract from the example above
18707 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18708 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18709 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18710 4 frontend_name fnt
18711 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18712 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18713 7 bytes_read* 212
18714 8 termination_state --
18715 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18716 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18717
18718Detailed fields description :
18719 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018720 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18721 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18722 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018723 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018724 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018725 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018726
18727 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018728 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18729 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18730 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018731
18732 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18733 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18734 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018735 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18736 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18737 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18738 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018739
18740 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18741 and processed the connection.
18742
18743 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18744 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18745 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18746 applications.
18747
18748 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18749 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18750 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18751 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18752 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18753
18754 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18755 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18756 See "Timers" below for more details.
18757
18758 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18759 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18760 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18761 "Timers" below for more details.
18762
18763 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018764 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018765 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18766 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18767 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18768 details.
18769
18770 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18771 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18772 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18773 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18774 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18775
18776 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18777 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18778 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18779 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18780 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18781 for more details.
18782
18783 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018784 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018785 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18786 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18787 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018788 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018789
18790 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18791 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18792 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18793 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18794 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18795 caused by a denial of service attack.
18796
18797 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18798 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18799 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18800 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18801 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18802 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18803 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18804 denial of service attack.
18805
18806 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18807 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18808 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18809 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18810 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18811 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18812 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18813 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18814 be processed than on other servers.
18815
18816 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18817 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18818 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18819 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18820 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18821 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18822 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18823 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18824 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18825 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18826 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18827 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18828 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18829
18830 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18831 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18832 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18833 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18834 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18835 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018836 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018837 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18838
18839 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18840 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18841 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18842 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18843 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18844 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018845 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018846 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18847 occurs.
18848
18849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188508.2.3. HTTP log format
18851----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018852
18853The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18854is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18855the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18856are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18857emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18858generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18859"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18860which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018861frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18862is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018863
18864Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18865slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18866with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18867
18868 Example :
18869 frontend http-in
18870 mode http
18871 option httplog
18872 log global
18873 default_backend bck
18874
18875 backend static
18876 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18877
18878 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18879 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18880 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018881 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018882
18883 Field Format Extract from the example above
18884 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18885 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018886 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018887 4 frontend_name http-in
18888 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018889 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018890 7 status_code 200
18891 8 bytes_read* 2750
18892 9 captured_request_cookie -
18893 10 captured_response_cookie -
18894 11 termination_state ----
18895 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18896 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18897 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18898 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18899 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018900
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018901Detailed fields description :
18902 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018903 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18904 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18905 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018906 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018907 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018908 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018909
18910 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018911 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18912 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18913 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018914
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018915 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18916 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018917
18918 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18919 and processed the connection.
18920
18921 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18922 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18923 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18924
18925 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18926 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18927 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18928 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18929 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18930 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18931
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018932 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18933 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18934 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018935 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018936 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18937 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018938 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18939 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018940
18941 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18942 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018943 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018944
18945 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18946 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018947 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18948 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018949
18950 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18951 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18952 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18953 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18954 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018955 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18956 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018957
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018958 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18959 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18960 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18961 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18962 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18963 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18964 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018965 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018966
18967 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18968 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18969 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18970
18971 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18972 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018973 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018974 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18975 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18976 overflowing.
18977
18978 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18979 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18980 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18981 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18982 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18983 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18984 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18985 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18986
18987 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18988 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18989 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18990 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18991 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18992 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18993 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18994 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18995
18996 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18997 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18998 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18999 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19000 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19001 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19002 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19003
19004 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019005 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019006 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19007 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19008 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019009 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019010 system.
19011
19012 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19013 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19014 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19015 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19016 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19017 caused by a denial of service attack.
19018
19019 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19020 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19021 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19022 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19023 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19024 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19025 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19026 denial of service attack.
19027
19028 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19029 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19030 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19031 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19032 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19033 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19034 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19035 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19036 processed than on other servers.
19037
19038 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19039 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19040 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19041 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19042 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19043 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19044 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19045 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19046 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19047 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19048 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19049 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19050 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19051
19052 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19053 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19054 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19055 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19056 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19057 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019058 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019059 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19060
19061 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19062 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19063 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19064 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19065 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19066 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019067 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019068 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19069 occurs.
19070
19071 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19072 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19073 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19074 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19075 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19076 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19077 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19078 cookies" below for more details.
19079
19080 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19081 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19082 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19083 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19084 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19085 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19086 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19087 and cookies" below for more details.
19088
19089 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19090 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19091 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19092 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19093 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19094 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19095 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19096 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19097
19098
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200190998.2.4. Custom log format
19100------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019101
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019102The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019103mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019104
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019105HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019106Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19107separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19108prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19109
19110Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19111variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019112("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019113
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019114If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019115as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019116less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19117the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19118
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019119Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19120"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19121delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19122preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019123
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019124Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19125'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19126https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19127such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19128
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019129Flags are :
19130 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019131 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019132 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19133 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019134
19135 Example:
19136
19137 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19138 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19139
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019140 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19141
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019142At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19143
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019144 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19145 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019146
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019147the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019148
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019149 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19150 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19151 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019152
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019153and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19154
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019155 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19156 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019157
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019158Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19159
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019160 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019161 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019162 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19163 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19164 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019165 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19166 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19167 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019168 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019169 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
19170 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019171 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019172 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19173 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019174 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019175 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019176 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019177 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019178 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019179 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019180 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019181 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19182 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19183 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19184 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19185 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019186 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019187 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019188 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019189 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019190 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019191 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19192 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019193 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19194 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19195 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019196 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019197 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19198 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019199 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019200 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19201 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19202 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019203 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019204 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019205 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19206 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19207 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19208 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019209 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019210 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019211 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019212 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019213 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019214 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019215 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19216 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19217 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019218 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019219 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19220 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019221 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019222 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19223 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019224 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019225 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019226 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019227 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019228
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019229 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019230
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019231
192328.2.5. Error log format
19233-----------------------
19234
19235When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19236protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19237By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19238"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019239will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019240logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19241
19242The format looks like this :
19243
19244 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19245 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19246 Connection error during SSL handshake
19247
19248 Field Format Extract from the example above
19249 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19250 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19251 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19252 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19253 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19254
19255These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19256failures.
19257
19258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192598.3. Advanced logging options
19260-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019261
19262Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19263just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19264options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19265for more information about their usage.
19266
19267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192688.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19269------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019270
19271It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19272haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19273commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19274monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19275ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19276
19277 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19278 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19279 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19280 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19281
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019282 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19283 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019284
19285 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19286 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19287 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19288
19289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19291----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019292
19293The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19294what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19295or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019296"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019297just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19298log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19299after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19300is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19301with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19302with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19303
19304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19306------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019307
19308Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19309for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19310"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19311retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19312raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19313a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19314file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19315you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19316"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19317
19318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193198.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19320--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019321
19322Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19323multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19324them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19325"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19326logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19327error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19328and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19329too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19330useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19331alternative.
19332
19333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193348.4. Timing events
19335------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019336
19337Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19338reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19339the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19340frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019341mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19342addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19343
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019344Timings events in HTTP mode:
19345
19346 first request 2nd request
19347 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19348 t tr t tr ...
19349 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19350 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19351 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19352 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019353 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019354 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19355
19356Timings events in TCP mode:
19357
19358 TCP session
19359 |<----------------->|
19360 t t
19361 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19362 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19363 |<------ Tt ------->|
19364
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019365 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019366 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019367 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19368 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19369 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019370 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019371 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19372 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19373 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19374 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019375
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019376 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19377 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19378 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019379 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19380 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19381 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19382 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19383 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19384 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019385
19386 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19387 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19388 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19389 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19390 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19391 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19392 request typed by hand during a test.
19393
19394 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19395 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019396 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019397 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19398 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19399 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19400 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019401
19402 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19403 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19404 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19405 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19406 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19407
19408 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19409 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19410 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19411 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19412 connection never established.
19413
19414 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19415 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19416 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19417 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19418 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19419 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19420 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19421 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19422 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19423 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19424 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19425
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019426 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19427 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19428 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19429 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19430 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19431 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19432
19433 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19434
19435 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19436 "Ta" can never be negative.
19437
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019438 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19439 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019440 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19441 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019442 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019443
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019444 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019445
19446 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019447 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19448 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019449
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019450 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19451 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19452 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19453 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19454 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19455 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19456 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19457 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19458
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019459These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19460protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19461that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019462due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19463"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19464that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019465
19466Most common cases :
19467
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019468 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19469 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19470 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19471 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19472 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19473 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19474 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19475 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19476 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19477 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19478 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019479 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019480
19481 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19482 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19483 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19484 of ms on remote networks.
19485
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019486 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19487 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19488 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019489
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019490 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19491 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19492 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19493 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19494 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19495 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19496 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19497 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19498 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019499
19500Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19501
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019502 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019503 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019504 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019505
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019506 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019507 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19508 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19509
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019510 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019511 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19512 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19513 flags.
19514
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019515 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19516 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019517 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19518 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19519 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19520 the client connection was maintained open.
19521
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019522 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019523 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019524 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019525 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19526
19527
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195288.5. Session state at disconnection
19529-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019530
19531TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19532"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
195332-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19534each of which has a special meaning :
19535
19536 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19537 session to terminate :
19538
19539 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19540
19541 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19542 server explicitly refused it.
19543
19544 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19545 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19546 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19547 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019548 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019549
19550 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19551 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019552
19553 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19554 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19555 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19556 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19557 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19558
19559 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19560 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19561 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19562 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19563 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19564
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019565 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19566 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19567
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019568 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19569 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19570 backup connections when going up.
19571
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019572 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19573
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019574 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19575 send or receive data.
19576
19577 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19578 send or receive data.
19579
19580 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19581 with nothing left in the buffers.
19582
19583 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19584
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019585 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019586 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19587
19588 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19589 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19590 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19591 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19592 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19593
19594 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19595 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19596
19597 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19598 server (HTTP only).
19599
19600 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19601
19602 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19603 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19604 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19605
19606 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19607 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19608 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19609
19610 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19611
19612 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19613 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19614
19615 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19616 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19617 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19618
19619 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19620 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019621 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19622 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019623
19624 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19625 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19626 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19627 another server.
19628
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019629 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019630 server.
19631
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019632 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19633 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19634 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19635 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19636
19637 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19638 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19639 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19640 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19641
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019642 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19643 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19644 "use-server" rule).
19645
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019646 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19647
19648 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19649 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19650
19651 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19652
19653 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19654 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19655 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19656
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019657 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19658 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019659 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019660 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19661 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19662
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019663 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19664
19665 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19666 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19667
19668 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19669
19670 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19671
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019672The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19673was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019674helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19675starvation, attacks, etc...
19676
19677The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19678alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19679easier finding and understanding.
19680
19681 Flags Reason
19682
19683 -- Normal termination.
19684
19685 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19686 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19687 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19688 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19689
19690 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19691 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19692 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19693 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19694 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19695 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019696
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019697 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19698 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019699 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019700
19701 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19702 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19703 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19704
19705 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19706 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19707 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19708 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19709 the server takes too long to respond.
19710
19711 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19712 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19713 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19714 long a time to respond.
19715
19716 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19717 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19718 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19719 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019720 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19721 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019722
19723 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19724 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19725 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19726 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19727 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019728 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019729 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19730 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19731 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19732 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19733 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19734 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19735 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19736 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019737 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019738 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19739 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19740 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019741
19742 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19743 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019744 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19745 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19746 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19747 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019748
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019749 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19750 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019752 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019753 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19754 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019755 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019756 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19757 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19758
19759 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19760 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19761 503 or 504 here.
19762
19763 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19764 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19765 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19766 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19767 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19768
19769 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19770 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019771 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019772 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19773 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19774
19775 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19776 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19777 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19778 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19779 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19780 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19781 between haproxy and the server.
19782
19783 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19784 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19785 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19786 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19787 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19788 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19789 solution is to fix the application.
19790
19791 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19792 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19793 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19794 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19795 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19796 external attacks.
19797
19798 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19799 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019800 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019801 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19802 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19803
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019804 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19805 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19806 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019807 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019808 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019809
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019810 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19811 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19812 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19813 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019814 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19815 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19816 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19817 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19818 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019819
19820 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19821 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19822 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19823 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19824
19825 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19826 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19827 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19828 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19829
19830 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19831 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19832 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19833 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19834
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019835The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19836persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19837important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19838re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19839
19840 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19841
19842 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19843 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19844 set on a GET request.
19845
19846 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19847 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019848 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019849 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19850
19851 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19852 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19853 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19854
19855 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19856 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19857 already got a cookie.
19858
19859 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19860 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19861 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19862 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19863 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19864
19865 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19866 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19867 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19868
19869 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19870 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19871 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19872
19873 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19874 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19875
19876 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19877 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19878 then advertised in the response.
19879
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198818.6. Non-printable characters
19882-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019883
19884In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19885consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19886converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19887prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19888being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19889escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19890is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19891'}' when logging headers.
19892
19893Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19894issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19895containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19896
19897Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19898the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19899performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19900
19901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19903---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019904
19905Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19906achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019907section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019908cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19909the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19910the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019911locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019912not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19913user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19914a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19915wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19916
19917 Examples :
19918 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19919 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19920
19921 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19922 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19923
19924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199258.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19926---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019927
19928Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19929proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19930the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19931server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19932
19933Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19934response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019935section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019936
19937It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019938time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19939appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019940are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19941and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19942follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19943request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19944in the logs.
19945
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019946As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19947frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19948an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19949
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019950 Example :
19951 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19952 listen proxy-out
19953 mode http
19954 option httplog
19955 option logasap
19956 log global
19957 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19958
19959 # log the name of the virtual server
19960 capture request header Host len 20
19961
19962 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19963 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19964
19965 # log the beginning of the referrer
19966 capture request header Referer len 20
19967
19968 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19969 capture response header Server len 20
19970
19971 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19972 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19973
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019974 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019975 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19976
19977 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19978 capture response header Via len 20
19979
19980 # log the URL location during a redirection
19981 capture response header Location len 20
19982
19983 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19984 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19985 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19986 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19987 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19988
19989 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19990 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19991 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19992 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019993 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019994
19995 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19996 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19997 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19998 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19999 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020000 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020001
20002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200038.9. Examples of logs
20004---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020005
20006These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20007them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20008reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20009
20010 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20011 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20012 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20013
20014 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20015 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20016
20017 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20018 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20019 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20020
20021 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20022 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20023
20024 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20025 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20026 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20027
20028 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020029 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020030 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20031 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20032
20033 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20034 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20035 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20036
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020037 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20038 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20039 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20040 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20041 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20042 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020043
20044 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020045 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020046
20047 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20048 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20049 Nothing was sent to any server.
20050
20051 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20052 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20053
20054 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20055 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020056 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020057 send a 408 return code to the client.
20058
20059 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20060 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20061
20062 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20063 5 seconds ("c----").
20064
20065 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20066 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020067 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020068
20069 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020070 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020071 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20072 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20073 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20074 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20075 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020076
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020077
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200200789. Supported filters
20079--------------------
20080
20081Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20082accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20083unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20084
20085See also : "filter"
20086
200879.1. Trace
20088----------
20089
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020090filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020091
20092 Arguments:
20093 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20094 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20095
20096 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
20097 the client and the server. By default, this filter
20098 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
20099 only parses a random amount of the available data.
20100
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020101 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020102 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20103 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20104 amount of the parsed data.
20105
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020106 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020107
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020108This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20109callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20110information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20111filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20112
20113Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20114tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20115a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20116
20117
201189.2. HTTP compression
20119---------------------
20120
20121filter compression
20122
20123The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20124keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020125when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20126fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20127done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20128explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20129filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20130listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20131order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020132
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020133See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20134 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020135
20136
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200201379.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20138--------------------------------------------
20139
20140filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20141
20142 Arguments :
20143
20144 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20145 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20146 parsed.
20147
20148 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20149 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20150 part must be placed in its own scope.
20151
20152The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20153external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020154streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020155exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20156also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20157
20158SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20159the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20160
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020161For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020162"doc/SPOE.txt".
20163
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100201649.4. Cache
20165----------
20166
20167filter cache <name>
20168
20169 Arguments :
20170
20171 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20172
20173The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20174"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020175cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020176other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20177case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20178is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20179filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020180listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20181order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020182
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020183See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20184 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20185
20186
201879.5. Fcgi-app
20188-------------
20189
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020190filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020191
20192 Arguments :
20193
20194 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20195
20196The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20197request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20198reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20199used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20200implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20201used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20202fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20203used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20204order.
20205
20206See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20207 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20208
20209
2021010. FastCGI applications
20211-------------------------
20212
20213HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20214feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20215the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20216FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20217servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20218FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20219backend.
20220
20221HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20222application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20223connection.
20224
2022510.1. Setup
20226-----------
20227
2022810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20229--------------------------
20230
20231fcgi-app <name>
20232 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20233 document root must be defined.
20234
20235acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20236 Declare or complete an access list.
20237
20238 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20239 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20240 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20241 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20242 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20243
20244docroot <path>
20245 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20246 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20247 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20248
20249index <script-name>
20250 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20251 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20252 is an optional setting.
20253
20254 Example :
20255 index index.php
20256
20257log-stderr global
20258log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20259 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20260 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20261
20262 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20263 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20264
20265pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20266 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20267 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20268 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20269
20270 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20271 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20272 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20273 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20274
20275 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20276 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20277
20278path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020279 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020280 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20281 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20282 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20283 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20284 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20285 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20286 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020287
20288 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020289 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020290 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20291 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20292 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20293 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020294
20295 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020296 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20297 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020298
20299option get-values
20300no option get-values
20301 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20302
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020303 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020304 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20305
20306 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20307 application will accept.
20308
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020309 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20310 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020311
20312 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020313 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020314 option is disabled.
20315
20316 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20317 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20318 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20319 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20320 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20321 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20322
20323option keep-conn
20324no option keep-conn
20325 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20326 sending a response.
20327
20328 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20329 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20330
20331option max-reqs <reqs>
20332 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20333 accept.
20334
20335 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20336 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20337 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20338 to 1.
20339
20340option mpxs-conns
20341no option mpxs-conns
20342 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20343
20344 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20345 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20346
20347set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20348 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20349 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20350 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20351 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20352
20353 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20354 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20355 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20356
20357 Example :
20358 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20359 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20360
20361 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20362
20363
2036410.1.2. Proxy section
20365---------------------
20366
20367use-fcgi-app <name>
20368 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20369
20370 Arguments :
20371 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20372
20373 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20374 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20375 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20376 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20377 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20378
20379 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20380 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20381 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20382 application are evaluated.
20383
20384
2038510.1.3. Example
20386---------------
20387
20388 frontend front-http
20389 mode http
20390 bind *:80
20391 bind *:
20392
20393 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20394 default_backend back-static
20395
20396 backend back-static
20397 mode http
20398 server www A.B.C.D:80
20399
20400 backend back-dynamic
20401 mode http
20402 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20403 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20404
20405 fcgi-app php-fpm
20406 log-stderr global
20407 option keep-conn
20408
20409 docroot /var/www/my-app
20410 index index.php
20411 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20412
20413
2041410.2. Default parameters
20415------------------------
20416
20417A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20418the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020419script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020420applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20421
20422 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20423 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20424 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20425 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20426 | | |
20427 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20428 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20429 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20430 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20431 | | application. |
20432 | | |
20433 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20434 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20435 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20436 | | |
20437 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20438 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20439 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20440 | | the application's configuration. |
20441 | | |
20442 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20443 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20444 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20445 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20446 | | |
20447 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20448 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20449 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20450 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20451 | | be defined. |
20452 | | |
20453 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20454 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20455 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20456 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20457 | | is not set too. |
20458 | | |
20459 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20460 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20461 | | set. |
20462 | | |
20463 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20464 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20465 | | the request. |
20466 | | |
20467 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20468 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20469 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20470 | | |
20471 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20472 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20473 | | script to process the request. |
20474 | | |
20475 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20476 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20477 | | |
20478 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20479 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20480 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20481 | | |
20482 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20483 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20484 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20485 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20486 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20487 | | |
20488 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20489 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20490 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20491 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20492 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20493 | | side. |
20494 | | |
20495 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20496 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20497 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20498 | | connected to. |
20499 | | |
20500 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20501 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20502 | | |
20503 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20504 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20505 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20506 | | |
20507 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20508
20509
2051010.3. Limitations
20511------------------
20512
20513The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20514way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20515during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20516establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20517application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20518or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20519message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20520these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20521and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20522
20523Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20524request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20525requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20526
20527About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20528into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20529fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20530"http-request" ones.
20531
20532Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20533FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20534processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20535must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20536here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020538/*
20539 * Local variables:
20540 * fill-column: 79
20541 * End:
20542 */